blob: d12a3ae1c0274bffe00195dba81bd026136f9e88 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue54b43a2019-11-25 19:47:40 +01007 2019/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200608 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200610 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100613 - presetenv
614 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - uid
616 - ulimit-n
617 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200618 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100619 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200620 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100629 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100630 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100631 - 51degrees-data-file
632 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200633 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200634 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200635 - wurfl-data-file
636 - wurfl-information-list
637 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200638 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100639 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100642 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200643 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200645 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100646 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100647 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100648 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200649 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200650 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200651 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200652 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200653 - noepoll
654 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000655 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100657 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300658 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000659 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100660 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200661 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200662 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200663 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000664 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000665 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200666 - tune.buffers.limit
667 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200669 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100670 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200671 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200672 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200673 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100674 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200675 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200676 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100677 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100678 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100679 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100680 - tune.lua.session-timeout
681 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200682 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100683 - tune.maxaccept
684 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200685 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200686 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200687 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100688 - tune.rcvbuf.client
689 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100690 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200691 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100692 - tune.sndbuf.client
693 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100694 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100695 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200696 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100697 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200698 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200699 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100700 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200701 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100702 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200703 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
704 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
705 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100706 - tune.zlib.memlevel
707 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100708
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200709 * Debugging
710 - debug
711 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712
713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007143.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715------------------------------------
716
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200717ca-base <dir>
718 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200719 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
720 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200721
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722chroot <jail dir>
723 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
724 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
725 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
726 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
727 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100729
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
731 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
732 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
733 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
734 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
735 set. These sets have the format
736
737 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
738
739 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100740 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
742 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100743 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
744 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100745 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100746 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100748 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
750 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
751 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
752 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100753
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100754 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
755 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
756 on the machine's word size.
757
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
760 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
761 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
762 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
763 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
764 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765
766 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100767 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
768
769 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
770 # first 4 CPUs
771
772 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
773 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
774 # word size.
775
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100776 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100777 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100778 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
779 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
780 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
781
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100782 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
783 # and so on.
784 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
786 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100788 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100789 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
790 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
791 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
792
793 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
794 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
795 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
796
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100797 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
798 # and a thread range.
799 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
800 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
802
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200803crt-base <dir>
804 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100805 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
806 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200807
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808daemon
809 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
810 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100811 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
812 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200813
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200814deviceatlas-json-file <path>
815 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100816 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200817
818deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100819 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200820 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
821
822deviceatlas-separator <char>
823 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
824 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
825
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100826deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200827 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
828 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
829 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100830
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900831external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
833 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100834 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
835 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
836 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
837 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
838 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900839
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200840gid <number>
841 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
842 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
843 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100844 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
845 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100847
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100848group <group name>
849 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
850 See also "gid" and "user".
851
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100852hard-stop-after <time>
853 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
854
855 Arguments :
856 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
857 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
858 SIGUSR1 signal.
859
860 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
861 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
862 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
863
864 Example:
865 global
866 hard-stop-after 30s
867
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200868h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
869 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
870 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
871 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
872 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
873 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
874 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
875 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
876 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
877 specified in a proxy.
878
879 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
880 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
881 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
882 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
883 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
884 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
885 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
886
887 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
888 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
889 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
890 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
891 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
892
893 Example:
894 global
895 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
896
897 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
898 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
899
900h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
901 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
902 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
903 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
904 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
905 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
906 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
907 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
908 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
909
910 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
911 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
912 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
913
914 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
915 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
916
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100917insecure-fork-wanted
918 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
919 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
920 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
921 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
922 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
923 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
924 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
925 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
926 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
927 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
928 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
929 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
930 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
931 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
932 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
933 disable it.
934
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100935insecure-setuid-wanted
936 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
937 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
938 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
939 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
940 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
941 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
942 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
943 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
944 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
945 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
946 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
947 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
948 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
949 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
950
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200951log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
952 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100953 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100954 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100955 configured with "log global".
956
957 <address> can be one of:
958
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100959 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100960 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
961 port).
962
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100963 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
964 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
965 port).
966
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100967 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100968 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
969 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100970 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100971
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100972 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
973 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
974 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
975 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
976 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
977 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
978 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
979 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
980 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
981 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
982 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
983 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
984 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
985 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100986 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
987 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100988
989 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
990 "fd@2", see above.
991
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200992 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
993 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
994 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
995 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
996 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
997
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200998 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
999 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001000
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001001 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1002 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1003 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1004 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1005 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1006 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1007 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1008 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1009 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1010 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001011 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1012 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001013
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001014 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1015 one of the following :
1016
1017 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1018 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1019
1020 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1021 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1022
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001023 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1024 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1025 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1026 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1027 logger consumes.
1028
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001029 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1030 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1031 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1032 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1033
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001034 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1035 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1036 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1037 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1038 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1039
1040 <sample_size>
1041 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1042 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1043 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1044 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1045 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1046
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001047 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001049 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1050 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1051 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1052
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001053 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1054 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1055 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1056 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057
1058 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001059 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1060 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1061 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1062 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1063 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1064 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001066 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001068log-send-hostname [<string>]
1069 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1070 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1071 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1072 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1073 the logs.
1074
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001075log-tag <string>
1076 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1077 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1078 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001079 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001080
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001081lua-load <file>
1082 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1083 used multiple times.
1084
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001085master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001086 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1087 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1088 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001089 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001090 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1091 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001092 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1093 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1094 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1095 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1096 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001097
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001098 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001099
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001100mworker-max-reloads <number>
1101 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001102 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001103 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1104 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1105 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1106
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107nbproc <number>
1108 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1109 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1110 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001111 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1112 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001113 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1114 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001116nbthread <number>
1117 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001118 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1119 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1120 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1121 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1122 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001123 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1124 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1125 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1126 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1127 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1128 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1129 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001132 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1134 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1135
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001136presetenv <name> <value>
1137 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1138 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1139 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1140 and "unsetenv".
1141
1142resetenv [<name> ...]
1143 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1144 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1145 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1146 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1147 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1148 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1149 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1150 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1151
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001152stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001153 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1154 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1155 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1156 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1157 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1158 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001159 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001160 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1161 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1162 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1163 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001164
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001165server-state-base <directory>
1166 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001167 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1168 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001169
1170server-state-file <file>
1171 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1172 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1173 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1174 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1175 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1176 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1177 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1178 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001179 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1180 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001181
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001182setenv <name> <value>
1183 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1184 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1185 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1186 and "unsetenv".
1187
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001188set-dumpable
1189 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001190 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1191 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1192 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1193 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1194 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1195 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1196 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1197 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1198 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1199 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1200 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1201 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1202 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1203 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1204 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1205 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1206 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001207
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001208ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1210 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001211 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001212 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001213 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1214 information and recommendations see e.g.
1215 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1216 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1217 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1218 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001219
1220ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1222 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1223 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1224 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1225 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001226 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1227 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1228 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001229 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001230
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001231ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1232 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1233 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1234 keyword to see available options.
1235
1236 Example:
1237 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001238 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001239
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001240ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1242 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001243 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001244 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001245 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1246 information and recommendations see e.g.
1247 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1248 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1249 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1250 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1251 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001252
1253ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1255 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1256 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1257 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1258 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001259 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1260 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1261 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1262 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001263
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001264ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1266 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1267 keyword to see available options.
1268
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001269ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1271 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1272 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001273 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001274 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001275 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1276 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1277 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1278 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001279 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1280 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1281 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1282
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001283ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1284 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1285 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1286 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1287
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001288stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1289 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1290 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1291 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001292 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001293 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001294
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001295 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1296 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1297 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001298
1299stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1300 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1301 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001302 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001303
1304stats maxconn <connections>
1305 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1306 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1307
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001308uid <number>
1309 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1310 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1311 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1312 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1313
1314ulimit-n <number>
1315 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1316 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1317 option.
1318
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001319unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1320 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1321
1322 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1323 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1324 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1325 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1326 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1327 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1328 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1329 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1330 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1331 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1332
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001333unsetenv [<name> ...]
1334 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1335 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1336 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1337 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1338 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1339 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1340 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342user <user name>
1343 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1344 See also "uid" and "group".
1345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001346node <name>
1347 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1348
1349 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1350 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1351 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1352 traffic.
1353
1354description <text>
1355 Add a text that describes the instance.
1356
1357 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1358 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1359 "<" and ">" characters.
1360
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100136151degrees-data-file <file path>
1362 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001363 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001364
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001365 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001366 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1367
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000136851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001369 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1370 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1371 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1372
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001374 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1375
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200137651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001377 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1378 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1379
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1381 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1382
138351degrees-cache-size <number>
1384 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1385 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1386 By default, this cache is disabled.
1387
1388 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001389 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1390
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001391wurfl-data-file <file path>
1392 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1393 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1394
1395 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1396 with USE_WURFL=1.
1397
1398wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1399 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1400 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1401 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1402
1403 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1404
1405 Valid WURFL properties are:
1406 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1407
1408 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1409 device.
1410
1411 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1412 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1413
1414 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1415 particular web request.
1416
1417 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1418 used Libwurfl API version.
1419
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001420 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1421 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1422
1423 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1424 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1425
1426 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1427
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001428 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1429 with USE_WURFL=1.
1430
1431wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1432 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1433 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1434
1435 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1436 with USE_WURFL=1.
1437
1438wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1439 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1440 thus before the chroot.
1441
1442 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1443 with USE_WURFL=1.
1444
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001445wurfl-cache-size <size>
1446 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1447 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001448 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001449 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001450
1451 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1452 with USE_WURFL=1.
1453
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001454strict-limits
1455 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1456 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1457 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1458 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1459 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1460 keyword.
1461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014623.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001463-----------------------
1464
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001465busy-polling
1466 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1467 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1468 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1469 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1470 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1471 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1472 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1473 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1474 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1475 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1476 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1477 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1478 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1479 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1480 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1481 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1482 "poll" pollers.
1483
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001484 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1485 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1486 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1487
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001488max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1489 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1490 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1491 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1492 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1493 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1494 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1495 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1496 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001498maxconn <number>
1499 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1500 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1501 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001502 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1503 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1504 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1505 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001506 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1507 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1508 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1509 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1510 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1511 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001512
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001513maxconnrate <number>
1514 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1515 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1516 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1517 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1518 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1519 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1520 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1521 fairness.
1522
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001523maxcomprate <number>
1524 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001526 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1527 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1528 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001529 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001530 default value.
1531
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001532maxcompcpuusage <number>
1533 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1534 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1535 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1536 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1537 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1538 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1539 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1540 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1541
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001542maxpipes <number>
1543 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1544 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1545 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1546 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1547 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1548 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1549
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001550maxsessrate <number>
1551 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1552 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1553 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1554 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1555 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1556 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1557 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1558 fairness.
1559
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001560maxsslconn <number>
1561 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1562 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1563 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1564 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1565 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1566 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1567 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001568 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1569 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1570 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1571 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1572 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1573 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1574 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001575
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001576maxsslrate <number>
1577 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1578 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1579 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1580 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1581 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1582 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1583 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1584 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1585 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1586 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1587
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001588maxzlibmem <number>
1589 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1590 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1591 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001592 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1593 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1594 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001596noepoll
1597 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1598 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001599 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001600
1601nokqueue
1602 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1603 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1604 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1605
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001606noevports
1607 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1608 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1609 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1610 also "nopoll".
1611
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001612nopoll
1613 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1614 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001616 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1617 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001618
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001619nosplice
1620 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001621 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001622 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001623 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001624 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1625 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1626 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1627 "option splice-response".
1628
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001629nogetaddrinfo
1630 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1631 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1632
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001633noreuseport
1634 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1635 command line argument "-dR".
1636
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001637profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1638 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1639 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1640 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1641 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001642 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001643 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1644 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1645 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1646 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1647
1648 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1649 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1650 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1651 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1652 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001653 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1654 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1655 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1656 CLI.
1657
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001658spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001659 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1660 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1661 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1662 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1663 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1664 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001666ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001667 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001668 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001669 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1670 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1671 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1672 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1673 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001674 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1675 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001676 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1677 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1678 openssl configuration file uses:
1679 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1680
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001681ssl-mode-async
1682 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001683 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001684 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1685 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1686 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001687 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001688 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001689
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001690tune.buffers.limit <number>
1691 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1692 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1693 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1694 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1695 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001696 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001697 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1698 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1699 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1700 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1701 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1702 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1703 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1704 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1705 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1706
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001707tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1708 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1709 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1710 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1711 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1712
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001713tune.bufsize <number>
1714 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1715 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1716 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1717 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1718 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1719 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1720 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001721 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1722 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1723 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001724 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001725 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1726 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1727 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001728
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001729tune.chksize <number>
1730 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1731 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1732 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1733 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1734 checks whenever possible.
1735
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001736tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1737 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1738 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1739 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1740 this value. The default value is 1.
1741
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001742tune.fail-alloc
1743 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1744 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1745 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1746 gracefully.
1747
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001748tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1749 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1750 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1751 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1752 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1753 change it.
1754
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001755tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1756 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001757 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1758 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001759 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1760 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1761 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1762 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1763 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1764
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001765tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1766 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1767 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1768 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1769 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1770 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1771 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1772 recommended not to change this value.
1773
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001774tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1775 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1776 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1777 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1778 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1779 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1780 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1781 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1782
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001783tune.http.cookielen <number>
1784 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1785 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1786 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1787 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1788 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1789 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1790 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1791 to change this value.
1792
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001793tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1795 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001796 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001797 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001798 configuration directives too.
1799 The default value is 1024.
1800
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001801tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1802 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1803 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1804 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1805 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1806 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1807 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001808 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1809 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1810 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001811
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001812tune.idletimer <timeout>
1813 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1814 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1815 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1816 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1817 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1818 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001819 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001820 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001821 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1822
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001823tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1824 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1825 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1826 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1827 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1828 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1829 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1830 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1831 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1832 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1833
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001834tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1835 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001836 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001837 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1838 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001839 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001840 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1841 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1842
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001843tune.lua.maxmem
1844 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1845 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1846 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1847 memory.
1848
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001849tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1850 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001851 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1852 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001853 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001854
1855tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1856 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1857 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1858 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1859 check servers.
1860
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001861tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1862 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1863 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1864 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001865 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001866
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001867tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001868 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1869 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1870 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1871 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1872 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1873 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1874 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1875 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1876 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1877 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001878
1879tune.maxpollevents <number>
1880 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1881 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1882 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1883 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1884 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1885
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001886tune.maxrewrite <number>
1887 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1888 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1889 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1890 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1891 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1892 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1893 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1894 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1895 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1896 bufsize.
1897
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001898tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1899 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1900 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1901 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1902 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1903 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1904 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1905 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1906 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1907 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001908 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1909 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001910 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1911 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1912 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1913 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1914 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1915 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1916 setting this parameter to 0.
1917
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001918tune.pipesize <number>
1919 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1920 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1921 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1922 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1923 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1924 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1925
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001926tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1927 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1928 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1929 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1930 default is 20.
1931
1932tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1933 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1934 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1935 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1936 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1937 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1938 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001939 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001940
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001941tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1942tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1943 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1944 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1945 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001946 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001947 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001948 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1949 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1950
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001951tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001952 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001953 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1954 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1955 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1956 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1957
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001958tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001959 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001960 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1961 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1962
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001963tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1964tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1965 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1966 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1967 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001968 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001970 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1971 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1972 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1973 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1974 notifying haproxy again.
1975
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001976tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001977 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1978 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1979 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001980 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001981 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001982 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001983 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1984 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1985 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001986 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1987 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001988
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001989tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001990 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001991 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1992 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1993 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1994 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1995 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1996
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001997tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1998 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001999 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002000 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2001 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2002 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2003 being used for too long.
2004
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002005tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2006 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2007 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2008 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2009 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2010 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2011 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2012 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2013 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2014 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2015 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002016 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002017 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002018
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002019tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2020 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2021 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2022 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2023 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2024 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2025 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2026 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002027 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2028 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002029
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002030tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2031 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2032 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2033 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2034 1000 entries.
2035
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002036tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2037 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2038 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2039 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2040
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002041tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002042tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002043tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2044tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2045tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002046 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2047 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2048 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2049 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2050 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2051 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2052 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2053 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002054
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002055 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2056 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2057 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2058 all available space is consumed.
2059 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2060 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2061 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002062
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002063tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2064 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002065 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002066 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002067 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002068 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2069
2070tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2071 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2072 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2074 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020763.3. Debugging
2077--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002078
2079debug
2080 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2081 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2082 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2083 system startup.
2084
2085quiet
2086 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2087 line argument "-q".
2088
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020903.4. Userlists
2091--------------
2092It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2093http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2094it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2095
2096userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002097 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002098 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2099
2100group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002101 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002102 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2103 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2104
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002105user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2106 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002107 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2108 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002109 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2110 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2111 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2112 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002113
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002114 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2115 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2116 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2117 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2118 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2119 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2120 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2121 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2122 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002123
2124 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002125 userlist L1
2126 group G1 users tiger,scott
2127 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002128
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002129 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2130 user scott insecure-password elgato
2131 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002132
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002133 userlist L2
2134 group G1
2135 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002136
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002137 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2138 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2139 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002140
2141 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002142
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002143
21443.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002145----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002146It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2147several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2148instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2149values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2150automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2151In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2152using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2153tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2154reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2155Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2156that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2157each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002158
2159peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002160 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002161 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2162
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002163bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2164 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2165 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2166
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002167disabled
2168 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2169 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2170 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2171
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002172default-bind [param*]
2173 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2174
2175default-server [param*]
2176 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2177
2178 Arguments:
2179 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2180 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2181 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2182 details.
2183
2184
2185 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2186
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002187enable
2188 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2189
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002190log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2191 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2192 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2193 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2194 more details.
2195
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002196peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002197 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2198 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2199 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2200 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2201 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2202 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2203
2204 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2205 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2206
2207 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2208 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2209 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2210 across all peers.
2211
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002212 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2213 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002214
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002215 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2216 "server" keyword explanation below).
2217
2218server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002219 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002220 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2221 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2222 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2223 of this "peers" section).
2224 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2225
2226
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002227 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002228 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002229 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002230 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2231 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2232 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002233
2234 backend mybackend
2235 mode tcp
2236 balance roundrobin
2237 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2238 stick on src
2239
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002240 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2241 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002242
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002243 Example:
2244 peers mypeers
2245 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2246 default-server ssl verify none
2247 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2248 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002249
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002250
2251table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2252 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2253
2254 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2255 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002256 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002257 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2258 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2259 "stick-table" keyword).
2260
2261 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2262 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2263 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2264 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2265 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2266 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2267 of the stick-table name as follows:
2268
2269 peers mypeers
2270 peer A ...
2271 peer B ...
2272 table t1 ...
2273
2274 frontend fe1
2275 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2276
2277 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2278 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2279
2280 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2281 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2282 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2283 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2284 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2285 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2286 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2287
2288 peers mypeers
2289 peer A ...
2290 peer B ...
2291 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2292
2293 backend t1
2294 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2295
2296 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2297 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2298 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2299
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023003.6. Mailers
2301------------
2302It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2303If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2304in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2305
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002306mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002307 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2308 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2309
2310mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2311 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2312
2313 Example:
2314 mailers mymailers
2315 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2316 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2317
2318 backend mybackend
2319 mode tcp
2320 balance roundrobin
2321
2322 email-alert mailers mymailers
2323 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2324 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2325
2326 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2327 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2328
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002329timeout mail <time>
2330 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2331 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2332 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2333 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2334
2335 Example:
2336 mailers mymailers
2337 timeout mail 20s
2338 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002339
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023403.7. Programs
2341-------------
2342In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2343master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2344managed the same way as the workers.
2345
2346During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2347sequence as a worker:
2348
2349 - the master is re-executed
2350 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2351 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2352 instance of the program
2353
2354During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2355
2356program <name>
2357 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2358 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2359 the management guide).
2360
2361command <command> [arguments*]
2362 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2363 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2364 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2365 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2366
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002367user <user name>
2368 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2369 See also "group".
2370
2371group <group name>
2372 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2373 See also "user".
2374
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002375option start-on-reload
2376no option start-on-reload
2377 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2378 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2379 program section.
2380
2381
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010023823.8. HTTP-errors
2383----------------
2384
2385It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2386imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2387several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2388
2389http-errors <name>
2390 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2391 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2392
2393errorfile <code> <file>
2394 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2395
2396 Arguments :
2397 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2398 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2399 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2400
2401 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2402 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2403 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2404 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2405 before any chroot is performed.
2406
2407 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2408
2409 Example:
2410 http-errors website-1
2411 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2412 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2413 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2414
2415 http-errors website-2
2416 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2417 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2418 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2419
2420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024214. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002422----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002424Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002425 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002426 - frontend <name>
2427 - backend <name>
2428 - listen <name>
2429
2430A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2431its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2432section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002434
2435A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2436connections.
2437
2438A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2439to forward incoming connections.
2440
2441A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2442parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002444All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2445'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2446case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2447
2448Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2449logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2450proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2451However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2452name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2453
2454Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2455and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002456bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2458modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2459arbitrary criteria.
2460
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002461In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2462a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002463the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002464
2465 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2466 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2467 between responses and new requests.
2468
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002469 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2470 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2471 client-facing connection remains open.
2472
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002473 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2474 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002475
2476The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2477frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2478following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002479weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002480
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002481 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002482
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002483 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2484 ----+-----+-----+----
2485 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2486 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002487 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2488 ----+-----+-----+----
2489 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024934.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2494--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002496The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2497limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2498they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2499limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002500marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002501option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002502and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2503with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2504specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002506
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002507 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2508------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2509acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002510backlog X X X -
2511balance X - X X
2512bind - X X -
2513bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514capture cookie - X X -
2515capture request header - X X -
2516capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002517compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002518cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002519declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002520default-server X - X X
2521default_backend X X X -
2522description - X X X
2523disabled X X X X
2524dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002525email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002526email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002527email-alert mailers X X X X
2528email-alert myhostname X X X X
2529email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002530enabled X X X X
2531errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002532errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002533errorloc X X X X
2534errorloc302 X X X X
2535-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2536errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002537force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002538filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539fullconn X - X X
2540grace X X X X
2541hash-type X - X X
2542http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002543http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002544http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002545http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002546http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002547http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002548http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002549id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002550ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002551load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002552log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002553log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002554log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002555log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002556max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002557maxconn X X X -
2558mode X X X X
2559monitor fail - X X -
2560monitor-net X X X -
2561monitor-uri X X X -
2562option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2563option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2564option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2565option allbackups (*) X - X X
2566option checkcache (*) X - X X
2567option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2568option contstats (*) X X X -
2569option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2570option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2572option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002573option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2574option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002575option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002576option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002577option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002578option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002579option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2581option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2582option httpchk X - X X
2583option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002584option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002586option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002587option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002588option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002589option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2590option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2591option logasap (*) X X X -
2592option mysql-check X - X X
2593option nolinger (*) X X X X
2594option originalto X X X X
2595option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002596option pgsql-check X - X X
2597option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002598option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002599option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002600option smtpchk X - X X
2601option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2602option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2603option splice-request (*) X X X X
2604option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002605option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002606option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2607option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2608-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002609option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002610option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2611option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2612option tcpka X X X X
2613option tcplog X X X X
2614option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002615external-check command X - X X
2616external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002617persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2618rate-limit sessions X X X -
2619redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002621retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002622retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002624server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002625server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002627stats admin - X X X
2628stats auth X X X X
2629stats enable X X X X
2630stats hide-version X X X X
2631stats http-request - X X X
2632stats realm X X X X
2633stats refresh X X X X
2634stats scope X X X X
2635stats show-desc X X X X
2636stats show-legends X X X X
2637stats show-node X X X X
2638stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002639-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2640stick match - - X X
2641stick on - - X X
2642stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002643stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002644stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002645tcp-check connect - - X X
2646tcp-check expect - - X X
2647tcp-check send - - X X
2648tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002649tcp-request connection - X X -
2650tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002651tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002652tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002653tcp-response content - - X X
2654tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002655timeout check X - X X
2656timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002657timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002659timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2660timeout http-request X X X X
2661timeout queue X - X X
2662timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002663timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002664timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002665timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002666transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002667unique-id-format X X X -
2668unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002669use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002670use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002671use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002672------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2673 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026764.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2677---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678
2679This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2680
2681
2682acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2683 Declare or complete an access list.
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 no | yes | yes | yes
2686 Example:
2687 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2688 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2689 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002691 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
2693
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002694backlog <conns>
2695 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2697 yes | yes | yes | no
2698 Arguments :
2699 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2700 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002701 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002702
2703 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2704 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2705 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2706 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2707 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2708 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2709 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2710 backlog parameter.
2711
2712 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2713 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2714 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2715
2716 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2717
2718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002720balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2723 yes | no | yes | yes
2724 Arguments :
2725 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2726 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2727 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2728 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2729
2730 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2731 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2732 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2733 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002734 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002735 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002736 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2737 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2738 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2739 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2740 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2741 it, so that you don't worry.
2742
2743 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2744 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2745 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2746 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2747 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2748 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2749 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2750 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002752 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2753 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2754 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2755 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2756 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2757 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2758 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2759 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2760
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002761 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002762 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002763 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2764 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002765 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002766 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2767 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2768 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2769 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2770 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002771 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2772 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2773 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2774 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2775 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2776 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2779 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2780 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2781 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2782 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2783 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2784 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2785 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002786 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002788 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2789 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2790 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002792 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2793 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2794 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2795 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2796 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2797 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2798 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2799 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2800 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2801 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2802 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2803 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002805 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002806 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2807 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2808 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2809 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2810 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2811 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2812 URIs start with a leading "/".
2813
2814 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2815 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2816 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2817 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002820 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2821
2822 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002823 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2824 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002825 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2826 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2827 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2828 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002829 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002830 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2831 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002832
2833 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2834 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2835 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2836 server will receive the request.
2837
2838 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2839 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2840 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2841 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2842 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002843 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2844 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2845 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002847 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2848 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2849 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2850 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2851 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002853 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002854 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2855 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2856 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2857
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002858 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2859 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2860 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2861
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002862 random
2863 random(<draws>)
2864 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002865 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2866 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2867 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2868 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002869 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2870 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2871 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2872 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2873 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2874 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2875 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2876 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2877 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2878 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2879 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2880 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2881 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2882 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2883 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2884 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2885 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2886 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2887 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2888 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002889
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002890 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002891 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002892 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2893 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2894 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2895 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2896 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2897 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002898 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002899 used instead.
2900
2901 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2902 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2903 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2904 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2905
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002906 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2907 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2908 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2909
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002910 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002913 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2914 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002915
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002916 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2917 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2918 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002919
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002920 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002921 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002922 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2923 NTLM relies on.
2924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925 Examples :
2926 balance roundrobin
2927 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002928 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002929 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2930 balance hdr(host)
2931 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002932
2933 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2934 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002936 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002937 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2938 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2939 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002940 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002941
2942 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2943 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2944 defaults to 16 kB.
2945
2946 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2947 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2948
2949 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2950 Round Robin.
2951
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002952 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002953 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2954 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2955 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2956
2957 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2958
2959 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002960 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002961 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2962 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2963 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002965 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002966
2967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002968bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2969bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2972 no | yes | yes | no
2973 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002974 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2975 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2976 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2977 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002978 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002979 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2980 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2981 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2982 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2983 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2984 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2985 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002986 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2987 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2988 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2989 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2990 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2991 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2992 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002993 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2994 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2995 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002996 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2997 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2998 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2999 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003000 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3001 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3002 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003003
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003004 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3005 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003006 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3007 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3008 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003009 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3010 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3011 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3012 the range.
3013
3014 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3015 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3016 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3017 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3018 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3019 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3020 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003021 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003022 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003023
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003024 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003025 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003026 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3027 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3028 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3029 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3030 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3031 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3032
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003033 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3034 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3035 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3036 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003037
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003038 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3039 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3040 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3041 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3042 in a frontend.
3043
3044 Example :
3045 listen http_proxy
3046 bind :80,:443
3047 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003048 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003050 listen http_https_proxy
3051 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003052 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003053
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003054 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3055 bind ipv6@:80
3056 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3057 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3058
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003059 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003060 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003061
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003062 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3063 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3064 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3065 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3066 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3067
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003068 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003069 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
3071
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003072bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003073 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | yes | yes | yes
3076 Arguments :
3077 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3078 may be used to override a default value.
3079
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003080 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003081 option may be combined with other numbers.
3082
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003083 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003084 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3085 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3086 missing from all processes.
3087
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003088 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003089 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003090 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3091 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3092 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3093 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3094 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003095 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003096
3097 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3098 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3099 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3100 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3101 and 'even' instances.
3102
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003103 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3104 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3105 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3106 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003107
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003108 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3109 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3110
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003111 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3112 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3113 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3114
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003115 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3116 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3117
3118 Example :
3119 listen app_ip1
3120 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003121 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003122
3123 listen app_ip2
3124 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003125 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003126
3127 listen management
3128 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003129 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003130
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003131 listen management
3132 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3133 bind-process 1-4
3134
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003135 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003136
3137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138capture cookie <name> len <length>
3139 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3141 no | yes | yes | no
3142 Arguments :
3143 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3144 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3145 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3146 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003147 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148
3149 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3150 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3151 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3152 right if it exceeds <length>.
3153
3154 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3155 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3156 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3157 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3158
3159 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3160 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3161 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3162
3163 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3164 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3165 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003166 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3167 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3168 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169
3170 Example:
3171 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3172
3173 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003174 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175
3176
3177capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003178 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3180 no | yes | yes | no
3181 Arguments :
3182 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003183 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3185 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3186 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3187
3188 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3189 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3190 it exceeds <length>.
3191
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003192 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3194 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003195 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3196 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3197 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3198 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003199 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003200 environments to find where the request came from.
3201
3202 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3203 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3204 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3205 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003207 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3208 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3209 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3210 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3211 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003212
3213 Example:
3214 capture request header Host len 15
3215 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003216 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003218 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219 about logging.
3220
3221
3222capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003223 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 no | yes | yes | no
3226 Arguments :
3227 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003228 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003229 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3230 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3231 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3232
3233 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3234 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3235 it exceeds <length>.
3236
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003237 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3239 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3240 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003241 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3242 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3243 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3244 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003245
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003246 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3247 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3248 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3249 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3250 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251
3252 Example:
3253 capture response header Content-length len 9
3254 capture response header Location len 15
3255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003256 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003257 about logging.
3258
3259
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003260compression algo <algorithm> ...
3261compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003262compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003263 Enable HTTP compression.
3264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3265 yes | yes | yes | yes
3266 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003267 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3268 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3269 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3270
3271 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003272 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3273 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3274 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003276 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003277 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003278
3279 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3280 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3281 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3282 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3283 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003284 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003285
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003286 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3287 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3288 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3289 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3290 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3291 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3292 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003293 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003294
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003295 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003296 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003297 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3298 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3299 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3300 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3301 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003302
3303 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3304 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3305 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3306 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3307 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003308 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3309 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3310 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3311 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3312 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003313 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3314 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003315
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003316 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003317 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3318 "Accept-Encoding" header
3319 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003320 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003321 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3322 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3323 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3324 "multipart"
3325 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3326 header
3327 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3328 and later
3329 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3330 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003331 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003332
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003333 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003334
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003335 Examples :
3336 compression algo gzip
3337 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003339
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003340cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003341 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3342 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003343 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003344 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 yes | no | yes | yes
3347 Arguments :
3348 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3349 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3350 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3351 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3352 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3353 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003354 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3356 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3357
3358 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3359 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3360 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3361 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3362 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3363 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003364 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3365 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003366 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003367 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3368 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003369
3370 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003371 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003372
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003373 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003374 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003375 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003376 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003377 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3378 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3379 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3380 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3381 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3382 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3383 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384
3385 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3386 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3387 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3388 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3389 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3390 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3391 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3392 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3393 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003394 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003395 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3396 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3397 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003398
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003399 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3400 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3401 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003402 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3403 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3404 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3405 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3407 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3408 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
3410 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3411 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3412 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3413 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3414 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3415 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3416 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3417 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3418 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3419
3420 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3421 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3422 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3423 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3424 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3425 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3426 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3427 persistence cookie in the cache.
3428 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3429
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003430 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3431 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3432 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3433 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3434 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003435 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003436 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3437 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3438 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3439 they logout.
3440
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003441 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3442 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3443 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3444 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3445
3446 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3447 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3448 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3449 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3450 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3451 this attribute.
3452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003453 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003454 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003455 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3456 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3457 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3458 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3459 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3460 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003461
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003462 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3463 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3464 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3465 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3466 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3467 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3468 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3469 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003470 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003471 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3472 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3473 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3474 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3475 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3476 the site.
3477
3478 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3479 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3480 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3481 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3482 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3483 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3484 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3485 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3486 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3487 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3488 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3489 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3490 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003491 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003492 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3493 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3494
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003495 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3496 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3497 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3498 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3499 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3500 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3503 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3504 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3505 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003506
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003507 Examples :
3508 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3509 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3510 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003511 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003512
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003513 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003515
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003516declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3517 Declares a capture slot.
3518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 no | yes | yes | no
3520 Arguments:
3521 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3522
3523 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3524 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3525 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3526 for use in the response.
3527
3528 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003529 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003530 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3531
3532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003533default-server [param*]
3534 Change default options for a server in a backend
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | no | yes | yes
3537 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003538 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3539 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3540 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3541 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003542
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003543 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003544 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3545
3546 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003547
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003548
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549default_backend <backend>
3550 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3552 yes | yes | yes | no
3553 Arguments :
3554 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3555
3556 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3557 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3558 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3559 will catch all undetermined requests.
3560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003561 Example :
3562
3563 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3564 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3565 default_backend dynamic
3566
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003567 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003568
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003570description <string>
3571 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3573 no | yes | yes | yes
3574 Arguments : string
3575
3576 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3577 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3578 it describes.
3579 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3580
3581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003582disabled
3583 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 yes | yes | yes | yes
3586 Arguments : none
3587
3588 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3589 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3590 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3591 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3592 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3593 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3594 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3595
3596 See also : "enabled"
3597
3598
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003599dispatch <address>:<port>
3600 Set a default server address
3601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3602 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003603 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003604
3605 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3606 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3607 during start-up.
3608
3609 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3610 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3611 possible with normal servers.
3612
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003613 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003614 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3615 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3616 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3617 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3618
3619 See also : "server"
3620
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003621
3622dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3623 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3625 yes | no | yes | yes
3626 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3627
3628 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003629 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003630 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3631 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003632 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003633 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635enabled
3636 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3638 yes | yes | yes | yes
3639 Arguments : none
3640
3641 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3642 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3643
3644 See also : "disabled"
3645
3646
3647errorfile <code> <file>
3648 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3650 yes | yes | yes | yes
3651 Arguments :
3652 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003653 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3654 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003655
3656 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003657 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003658 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003659 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3660 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003661
3662 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3663 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3664 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3665
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003666 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3669 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3670 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3671 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3672
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003673 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3674 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003675 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003676 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3677 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3678 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3679
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003680 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3681 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3682 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003683 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3685
3686 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3687
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003688 Example :
3689 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003690 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003691 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3692 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3693
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003694
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003695errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3696 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3697 section.
3698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3699 yes | yes | yes | yes
3700 Arguments :
3701 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3702
3703 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3704 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3705 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3706
3707 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3708 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3709 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3710 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3711 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3712 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3713 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3714
3715 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3716 3.8 about http-errors.
3717
3718 Example :
3719 errorfiles generic
3720 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3721
3722
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003723errorloc <code> <url>
3724errorloc302 <code> <url>
3725 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 yes | yes | yes | yes
3728 Arguments :
3729 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003730 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3731 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003732
3733 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3734 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3735 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3736 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003737 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738
3739 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3740 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3741 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3742
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003743 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3744
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003745 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3746 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3747 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3748 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003749 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003750 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3751 request.
3752
3753 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3754
3755
3756errorloc303 <code> <url>
3757 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | yes | yes | yes
3760 Arguments :
3761 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003762 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3763 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003764
3765 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3766 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3767 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3768 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003769 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770
3771 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3772 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3773 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3774
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003775 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3776
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003777 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3778 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3779 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3780 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003781 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003782
3783 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3784
3785
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003786email-alert from <emailaddr>
3787 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003788 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 yes | yes | yes | yes
3791
3792 Arguments :
3793
3794 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3795
3796 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3797 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3798
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003799 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003800 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3801 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003802
3803
3804email-alert level <level>
3805 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3806 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3808 yes | yes | yes | yes
3809
3810 Arguments :
3811
3812 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3813 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3814 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3815
3816 By default level is alert
3817
3818 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3819 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3820 for the proxy.
3821
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003822 Alerts are sent when :
3823
3824 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3825 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3826 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3827 is notice or lower
3828 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3829 and a health check status update occurs
3830
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003831 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3832 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003833 section 3.6 about mailers.
3834
3835
3836email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3837 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | yes | yes | yes
3840
3841 Arguments :
3842
3843 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3844
3845 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3846 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3847
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003848 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3849 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003850
3851
3852email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3853 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3854 mailers.
3855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | yes | yes | yes
3857
3858 Arguments :
3859
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003860 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003861
3862 By default the systems hostname is used.
3863
3864 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3865 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3866 for the proxy.
3867
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003868 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3869 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003870
3871
3872email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003873 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003874 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3876 yes | yes | yes | yes
3877
3878 Arguments :
3879
3880 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3881
3882 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3883 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3884
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003885 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003886 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3887
3888
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003889force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3890 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003892 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003893
3894 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3895 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3896 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3897 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3898 marked down for maintenance operations.
3899
3900 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3901 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3902 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3903 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3904 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3905 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3906 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3907 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3908 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3909
3910 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3911 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3912 is used.
3913
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003914 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003915 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003916
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003917
3918filter <name> [param*]
3919 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3921 no | yes | yes | yes
3922 Arguments :
3923 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3924 referenced in section 9.
3925
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003926 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003927 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003928 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3929 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003930
3931 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3932 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3933
3934 Example:
3935 listen
3936 bind *:80
3937
3938 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3939 filter compression
3940 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3941
3942 compression algo gzip
3943 compression offload
3944
3945 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3946
3947 See also : section 9.
3948
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003949
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003950fullconn <conns>
3951 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3953 yes | no | yes | yes
3954 Arguments :
3955 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3956 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3957
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003958 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003959 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003960 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003961 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3962 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3963 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3964 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3965 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003966 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003967
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003968 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3969 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003970 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3971 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3972 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003973
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003974 Example :
3975 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3976 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3977 # connections.
3978 backend dynamic
3979 fullconn 10000
3980 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3981 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3982
3983 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3984
3985
3986grace <time>
3987 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003989 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003990 Arguments :
3991 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3992 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3993 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3994
3995 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3996 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003997 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003998 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3999
4000 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4001 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4002 simplify it.
4003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004005hash-balance-factor <factor>
4006 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4008 yes | no | no | yes
4009 Arguments :
4010 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4011 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004012 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004013
4014 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4015 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4016 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4017 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4018 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4019 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4020 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4021
4022 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4023 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4024 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4025 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4026 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4027
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004028 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4029 consistent hashing mechanism.
4030
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004031 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4032
4033
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004034hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004035 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4037 yes | no | yes | yes
4038 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004039 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4040 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004041
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004042 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4043 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4044 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4045 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4046 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4047 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4048 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4049 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4050 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4051 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004052
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004053 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4054 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4055 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4056 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4057 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4058 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4059 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4060 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4061 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4062 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4063 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4064 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4065 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004066 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4067 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004068
4069 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4070
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004071 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004072 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4073 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4074 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004075 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4076 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4077 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004078
4079 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4080 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004081 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4082 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4083 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4084 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4085
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004086 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4087 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4088 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4089 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4090 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4091 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4092 parameter.
4093
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004094 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4095 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4096 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4097 used on strings.
4098
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004099 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4100
4101 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4102 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4103 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4104 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4105 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4106 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4107 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4108 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4109 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4110 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4111 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4112 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004113
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004114 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4115 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4116 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004117
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004118 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004119
4120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121http-check disable-on-404
4122 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004124 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004125 Arguments : none
4126
4127 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4128 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4129 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4130 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4131 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4132 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4133 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4134 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004135 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4136 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4137 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4138
4139 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4140
4141
4142http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004143 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004145 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004146 Arguments :
4147 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4148 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004149 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004150 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4151 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4152 details on the supported keywords.
4153
4154 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4155 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4156 with the usual backslash ('\').
4157
4158 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4159 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4160 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4161 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4162 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4163
4164 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004165 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004166 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4167 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4168 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4169
4170 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004171 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004172 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4173 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4174 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4175 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4176
4177 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004178 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004179 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4180 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4181 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4182 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4183 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004184 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004185 trace).
4186
4187 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004188 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004189 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4190 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4191 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4192 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4193 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004194 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004195
4196 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4197 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4198 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4199 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4200 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4201 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4202 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4203 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4204
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004205 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4206 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4207 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4208
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004209 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4210 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4211
4212 Examples :
4213 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004214 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004215
4216 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004217 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004218
4219 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004220 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004221
4222 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004223 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004225 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004226
4227
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004228http-check send-state
4229 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4231 yes | no | yes | yes
4232 Arguments : none
4233
4234 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4235 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4236 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4237 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4238 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4239
4240 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4241 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4242 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4243 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4244 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004245 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4246 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4247 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4248
4249 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4250 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4251 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4252
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004253 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4254 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4255 checked in multiple backends.
4256
4257 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4258 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4259
4260 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4261 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4262 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4263 one fails.
4264
4265 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4266 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4267 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4268
4269 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4270 server's queue.
4271
4272 Example of a header received by the application server :
4273 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4274 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4275
4276 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278
4279http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004280 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4281
4282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | yes
4284
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004285 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4286 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4287 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4288 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4289 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4292 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296 Example:
4297 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4298 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4299 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301 http-request allow if nagios
4302 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4303 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4304 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 Example:
4307 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4308 acl add path /addacl
4309 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4314 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316 Example:
4317 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4318 acl setmap path /setmap
4319 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004323 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4324 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4327 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4332 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4333 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4334 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4335 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4336 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4337 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4338 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4343 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4344 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4345 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4346 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4347 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4348 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4349 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4354 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004355
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4360 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4361 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4362 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4363 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365 Example:
4366 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4367 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004368
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004369http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004370
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004371 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004373http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4377 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4378 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4379 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4380 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4381 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4382 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4383 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4384 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4387 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4388 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4389 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4390 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4391 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004393http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4396 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4397 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4398 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4399 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4400 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004402http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004406http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004408 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4409 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4410 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4411 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4412 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4413 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004415http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004417 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4418 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4419 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4420 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4421 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004422
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004423http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4424 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4425 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4426 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4427
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004428http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4429
4430 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4431 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4432 pointed by <resolvers>.
4433 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4434 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4435 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4436 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4437 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4438 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4439 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4440 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4441 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4442 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4443 to 0.0.0.0.
4444
4445 Example:
4446 resolvers mydns
4447 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4448 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4449 timeout retry 1s
4450 hold valid 10s
4451 hold nx 3s
4452 hold other 3s
4453 hold obsolete 0s
4454 accepted_payload_size 8192
4455
4456 frontend fe
4457 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4458 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4459 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4460
4461 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4462 # which mean DNS resolution error
4463 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4464
4465 default_backend be
4466
4467 backend b_503
4468 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4469 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4470 # 503 error page to end users
4471
4472 backend be
4473 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4474 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4475 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4476 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4477 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4478
4479 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4480 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4481
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004482http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4483
4484 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4485 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4486 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4487 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004488 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4489 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004490
4491 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004493http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004495 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4496 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4497 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4498 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4499 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004503 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4504 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4505 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4506 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004508http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4509 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004510
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004511 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4512 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4513 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4514 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4515 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4516 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004517
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004518 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4519 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4520 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4521 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4522 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004523
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004524 Example:
4525 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4526
4527 # applied to:
4528 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4529
4530 # outputs:
4531 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4532
4533 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004534
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004535 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4536
4537 # applied to:
4538 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004539
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004540 # outputs:
4541 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004542
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004543http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4544 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4545
4546 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4547 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4548 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4549 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4550
4551 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4552 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4553 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4554
4555 Example:
4556 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4557 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4558
4559 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4560 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4561
4562 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4563 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4564 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4565 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4566
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004567http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4568 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4569
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004570 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4571 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4572 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4573 against.
4574
4575 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4576 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4577 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004578
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004579 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4580 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4581 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4582 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4583 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4584 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4585 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4586 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4587 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004588 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4589 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004590
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004591 Example:
4592 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4593 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004594
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004595 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4596 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004598http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4599 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004600
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004601 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4602 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4603 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4604 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004605
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004606 Example:
4607 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004608
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004609 # applied to:
4610 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004611
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004612 # outputs:
4613 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004615http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4616http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004618 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4619 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4620 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004621
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004622http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4623 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004624
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004625 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4626 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4627 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4628 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004630http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004632 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4633 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4634 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4635 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4636 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004638 Arguments:
4639 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4640 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004642 Example:
4643 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4644 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004646 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4647 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004651 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4652 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4653 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655 Arguments:
4656 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4657 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004659 Example:
4660 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4661 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4664 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4665 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004667http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4670 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4671 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4672 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4673 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004675 Example:
4676 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4677 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4678 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4679 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4680 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4681 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4682 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4683 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4684 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004686http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004688 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4689 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4690 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4691 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4692 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004694http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4695 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004696
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004697 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4698 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4699 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4700 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4701 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4702 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4703 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4704 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4705 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004707http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004709 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4710 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4711 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4712 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4713 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4714 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4715 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004719 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4720 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4721 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004723http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004725 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4726 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4727 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4728 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4729 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4730 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4731 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4732 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004734http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004736 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4737 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4738 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4739 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4740 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4741 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004743 Example :
4744 # prepend the host name before the path
4745 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004747http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004749 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4750 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4751 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4752 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4753 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004755http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004757 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4758 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4759 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4760 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4761 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4762 values have higher priority.
4763 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4764 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4765 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4766 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4767 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004769http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004771 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4772 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4773 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4774 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4775 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4776 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4777 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004778
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004779 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004780
4781 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004782 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4783 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004785http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4786 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4787 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4788 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4789 privacy.
4790
4791 Arguments :
4792 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4793 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004794
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004795 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004796 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4797 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4798
4799 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4800 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4801
4802http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4803
4804 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4805 expression.
4806
4807 Arguments:
4808 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4809 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004810
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004811 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004812 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4813 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4814
4815 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4816 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4817 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4818
4819http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4820
4821 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4822 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4823 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4824 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4825 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4826 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4827 information from the request.
4828
4829 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4830
4831http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4832
4833 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4834 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4835 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4836 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4837 path and the query string.
4838 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4839
4840http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4841
4842 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4843 inline.
4844
4845 Arguments:
4846 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4847 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4848 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4849 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4850 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4851 (request and response)
4852 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4853 processing
4854 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4855 processing
4856 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4857 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4858 and '_'.
4859
4860 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4861 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004862
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004863 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004864 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004865
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004866http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4867 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004868
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004869 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4870 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4871 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4872 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4873 agent name must be used.
4874
4875 Arguments:
4876 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4877
4878 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4879 configuration.
4880
4881http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4882
4883 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4884 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4885 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4886 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4887 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4888 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4889 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4890 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4891 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4892 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4893 action.
4894 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4895 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4896 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4897 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4898 you fully understand how it works.
4899
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004900http-request strict-mode { on | off }
4901
4902 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4903 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4904 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4905 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4906 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4907 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
4908 processing.
4909
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01004910 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004911 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4912 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
4913 rules evaluation.
4914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004915http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4916
4917 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4918 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4919 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4920 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4921 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4922 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4923 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4924 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4925 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4926 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4927 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4928 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4929 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4930
4931http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4932http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4933http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4934
4935 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4936 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4937 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4938 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4939 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4940 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4941 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4942 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4943 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4944 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4945 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4946 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4947
4948 Arguments :
4949 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4950 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4951 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4952 select which table entry to update the counters.
4953
4954 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4955 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4956 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4957 that table until the session ends.
4958
4959 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4960 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4961 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4962 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4963 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4964 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4965 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4966 useful information.
4967
4968 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4969 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4970 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4971 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4972 checks that make use of it.
4973
4974http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4975
4976 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004977
4978 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004979 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004980
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004981http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4982
4983 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4984 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4985 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4986 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4987 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4988 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4989
4990 Arguments :
4991 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4992
4993 Example:
4994 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4995
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004996http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004998 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4999 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5000 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005001
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005003http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005004 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5005
5006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5007 no | yes | yes | yes
5008
5009 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5010 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5011 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5012 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5013 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5014 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5017 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005019 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005021 Example:
5022 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005024 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005026 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5027 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005029 Example:
5030 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005032 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5035 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5038 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005040http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005042 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5043 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5044 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5045 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5046 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5047 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5048 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5049 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005053 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5054 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5055 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5056 example, or to pass some internal information.
5057 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5058 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5059 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005061http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005063 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5064 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005065
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005066http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005067
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005068 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005070http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005072 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5073 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5074 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5075 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5076 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5077 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5078 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005080 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5081 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5082 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5083 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5084 keyword.
5085 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
5086 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005088http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005090 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5091 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5092 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5093 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5094 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5095 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005097http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005099 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005101http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005103 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5104 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5105 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5106 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5107 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5108 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005109
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005110http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005112 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005113 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5114 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
5115 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
5116 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005118http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005120 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5121 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5122 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5123 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5124 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5125 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005127http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5128 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005129
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005130 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5131 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005132
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005133 Example:
5134 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005135
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005136 # applied to:
5137 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005139 # outputs:
5140 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005141
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005142 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005144http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5145 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005146
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005147 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005148 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005149
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005150 Example:
5151 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005153 # applied to:
5154 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005155
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005156 # outputs:
5157 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005158
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005159http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5160http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005161
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005162 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5163 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5164 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005165
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005166http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5167 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005168
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005169 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5170 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5171 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5172 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005173
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005174http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005176 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5177 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5178 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5179 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5180 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005182 Arguments:
5183 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005185 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5186 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005188http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005190 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5191 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5192 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005194http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5195
5196 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5197 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5198 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5199 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5200 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5201
5202http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5203
5204 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5205 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5206 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5207 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5208 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5209 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5210 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5211 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5212 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5213
5214http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5215
5216 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5217 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5218 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5219 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5220 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5221 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5222 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5223
5224http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5225
5226 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5227 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5228 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5229 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5230 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5231 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5232 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5233 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5234
5235http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5236 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5237
5238 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5239 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5240 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5241 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005242
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005243 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005244 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5245 http-response set-status 431
5246 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5247 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005249http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005250
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005251 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5252 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5253 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5254 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5255 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5256 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5257 based on some information from the request.
5258
5259 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5260
5261http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5262
5263 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5264 inline.
5265
5266 Arguments:
5267 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5268 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5269 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5270 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5271 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5272 (request and response)
5273 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5274 processing
5275 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5276 processing
5277 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5278 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5279 and '_'.
5280
5281 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5282 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005283
5284 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005285 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005287http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005288
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005289 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5290 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5291 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5292 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5293 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5294 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5295 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5296 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5297 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5298 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5299 action.
5300 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5301 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5302 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5303 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5304 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005305
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005306http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5307
5308 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5309 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5310 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5311 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5312 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5313 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5314 processing.
5315
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005316 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005317 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5318 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5319 rules evaluation.
5320
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005321http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5322http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5323http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005325 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5326 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5327 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5328 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5329 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5330 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5331
5332http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5333
5334 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5335 about <var-name>.
5336
5337 Example:
5338 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5339
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005340
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005341http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5342 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5343
5344 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 yes | no | yes | yes
5346
5347 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005348 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5349 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5350 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005351
5352 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5353
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005354 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5355 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5356 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5357 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5358 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5359 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5360 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5361 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5362 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5363 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005364
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005365 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5366 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5367 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5368 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5369 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5370 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5371 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5372 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005373
5374 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5375 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5376 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5377 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5378 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5379 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5380 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5381 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005382 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005383 downsides of rare connection failures.
5384
5385 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5386 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5387 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5388 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5389 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5390 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005391 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005392 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5393 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5394 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5395 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5396 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5397
5398 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005399 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5400 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5401 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005402
5403 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005404 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005405
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005406 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5407 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005408
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005409 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005410
5411 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5412 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5413 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5414
5415 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5416
5417
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005418http-send-name-header [<header>]
5419 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005420 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5421 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005422 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005423 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5424
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005425 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5426 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5427 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5428 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5429 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5430 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5431 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5432 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5433 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5434 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5435 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5436 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5437 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5438 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5439 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5440 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005441
5442 See also : "server"
5443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005444id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005445 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5447 no | yes | yes | yes
5448 Arguments : none
5449
5450 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5451 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5452 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005453
5454
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005455ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5456 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5457 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005458 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005459
5460 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5461 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5462 and running).
5463
5464 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5465 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5466 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005467 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005468 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5469
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005470 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5471 "unless" condition is met.
5472
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005473 Example:
5474 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5475 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5476 ignore-persist if url_static
5477
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005478 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5479
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005480load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5481 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5483 yes | no | yes | yes
5484
5485 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5486 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5487 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005488 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005489 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5490 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5491 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5492 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5493
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005494 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005495 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005496 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005497
5498 Arguments:
5499 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5500 named "server-state-file".
5501
5502 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5503 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5504 name is used as a file name.
5505
5506 none don't load any stat for this backend
5507
5508 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005509 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5510 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5511 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005512 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005513 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005514
5515 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5516 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5517
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005518 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005519
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005520 global
5521 stats socket /tmp/socket
5522 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005523
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005524 defaults
5525 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005526
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005527 backend bk
5528 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5529 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005530
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005531
5532 Then one can run :
5533
5534 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5535
5536 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5537
5538 1
5539 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5540 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5541 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5542
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005543 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005544
5545 global
5546 stats socket /tmp/socket
5547 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5548
5549 defaults
5550 load-server-state-from-file local
5551
5552 backend bk
5553 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5554 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5555
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005556
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005557 Then one can run :
5558
5559 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5560
5561 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5562
5563 1
5564 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5565 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5566 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5567
5568 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5569 "show servers state"
5570
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005571
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005572log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005573log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5574 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005575no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005576 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5578 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005579
5580 Prefix :
5581 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5582 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5583 prefix does not allow arguments.
5584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005585 Arguments :
5586 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5587 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5588 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5589 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5590 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5591 parameter.
5592
5593 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5594 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5595
5596 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5597 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5598 standard syslog port).
5599
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005600 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5601 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5602 standard syslog port).
5603
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005604 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5605 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5606 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005607 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005608
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005609 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5610 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5611 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5612 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5613 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5614 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5615 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5616 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5617 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5618 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5619 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5620 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5621 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5622 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5623 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5624 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005625 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5626 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005627
5628 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5629 and "fd@2", see above.
5630
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005631 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5632 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5633 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5634 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5635 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5636 having the logs instantly available.
5637
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005638 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5639 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005640
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005641 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5642 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5643 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5644 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5645 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5646 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5647 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5648 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5649 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5650 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005651 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005652
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005653 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5654 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5655 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5656 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5657 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5658
5659 <sample_size>
5660 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5661 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5662 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5663 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5664 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5665
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005666 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5667 one of the following :
5668
5669 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5670 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5671
5672 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5673 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5674
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005675 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5676 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5677 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5678 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5679 systemd logger consumes.
5680
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005681 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5682 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5683 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5684 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5685
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005686 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5687
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005688 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5689 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5690 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5691
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005692 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5693 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5694 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5695 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005696
5697 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5698 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5699 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005700 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5701 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5702 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5703 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5704 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005705
5706 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5707
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005708 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5709 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5710 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005711
5712 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5713 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5714 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5715 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5716
5717 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5718 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005719
5720 Example :
5721 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005722 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5723 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5724 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005725 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5726 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005728
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005729
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005730log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005731 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5732 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5733 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005734
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005735 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5736 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5737 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5738 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5739 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005740
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005741 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5742 "option httplog" directives.
5743
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005744log-format-sd <string>
5745 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5746 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5747 yes | yes | yes | no
5748
5749 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5750 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5751 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5752 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5753 which covers the log format string in depth.
5754
5755 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5756 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5757
5758 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5759 log format to "rfc5424".
5760
5761 Example :
5762 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5763
5764
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005765log-tag <string>
5766 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5767 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5768 yes | yes | yes | yes
5769
5770 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5771 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5772 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5773 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5774 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5775 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5776 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5777 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5778 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005779
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005780max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5781 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5782 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5783 yes | no | yes | yes
5784
5785 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5786 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5787 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5788 servers.
5789
5790 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5791 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5792 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5793 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5794 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005795 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005796 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5797 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5798 picking a different server.
5799
5800 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5801 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5802 even if they have to be queued.
5803
5804 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5805 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5806
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005807max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5808 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5809 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5810 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005811
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005812maxconn <conns>
5813 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5815 yes | yes | yes | no
5816 Arguments :
5817 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5818 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5819 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5820 closes.
5821
5822 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5823 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5824 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5825 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005826 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5827 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5828 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5829 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005830
5831 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5832 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5833 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5834
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005835 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5836 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005837
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005838 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5839
5840
5841mode { tcp|http|health }
5842 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5844 yes | yes | yes | yes
5845 Arguments :
5846 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5847 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5848 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5849 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5850
5851 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5852 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5853 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5854 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5855 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5856
5857 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005858 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5859 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5860 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5861 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5862 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5863 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5864 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005865
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005866 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5867 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5868 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005869
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005870 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005871 defaults http_instances
5872 mode http
5873
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005874 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005876
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005877monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005878 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5880 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005881 Arguments :
5882 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5883 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005884 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005885 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5886 backend and its backup.
5887
5888 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5889 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5890 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5891 servers in a list of backends.
5892
5893 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5894 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5895 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5896 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5897 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5898 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5899 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005900 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5901 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005902
5903 Example:
5904 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005905 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005906 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5907 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5908 monitor-uri /site_alive
5909 monitor fail if site_dead
5910
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005911 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005912
5913
5914monitor-net <source>
5915 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5917 yes | yes | yes | no
5918 Arguments :
5919 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5920 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5921 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5922 followed by a mask.
5923
5924 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5925 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005926 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005927 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5928
5929 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5930 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5931 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5932 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005933 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5934 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5935 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005936
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005937 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5938 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5939 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5940 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5941 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5942 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005943
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005944 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5945 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005946
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005947 Example :
5948 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5949 frontend www
5950 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5951
5952 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5953
5954
5955monitor-uri <uri>
5956 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5958 yes | yes | yes | no
5959 Arguments :
5960 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5961 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5962
5963 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5964 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5965 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5966 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5967 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5968 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5969 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5970 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5971
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005972 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005973 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5974 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5975 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5976 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5977 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5978 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005979
5980 Example :
5981 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5982 frontend www
5983 mode http
5984 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5985
5986 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5987
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005988
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005989option abortonclose
5990no option abortonclose
5991 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5993 yes | no | yes | yes
5994 Arguments : none
5995
5996 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5997 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5998 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5999 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006000 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006001 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6002 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6003 encountered while delivering the response.
6004
6005 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6006 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6007 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6008 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6009 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6010 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006011 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006012 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006013 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006014 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6015 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6016 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6017
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006018 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6019 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006020 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6021 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6022 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6023 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6024 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6025 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006026 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006027
6028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6030
6031 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6032
6033
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006034option accept-invalid-http-request
6035no option accept-invalid-http-request
6036 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6038 yes | yes | yes | no
6039 Arguments : none
6040
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006041 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006042 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006043 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006044 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6045 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6046 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6047 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6048 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006049 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6050 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6051 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6052 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006053 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006054 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006055 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6056 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6057 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006058
6059 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6060 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6061 been confirmed.
6062
6063 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6064 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006065 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6066 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006067 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6068
6069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6071
6072 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6073 stats socket.
6074
6075
6076option accept-invalid-http-response
6077no option accept-invalid-http-response
6078 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6080 yes | no | yes | yes
6081 Arguments : none
6082
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006083 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006084 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006085 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006086 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6087 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6088 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6089 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6090 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006091 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6092 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6093 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006094
6095 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6096 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6097 been confirmed.
6098
6099 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6100 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6101 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6102 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6103
6104 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6105 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6106
6107 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6108 stats socket.
6109
6110
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006111option allbackups
6112no option allbackups
6113 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6115 yes | no | yes | yes
6116 Arguments : none
6117
6118 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6119 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6120 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6121 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6122 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6123 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6124 order between the backup servers anymore.
6125
6126 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6127 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6128
6129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6131
6132
6133option checkcache
6134no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006135 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6137 yes | no | yes | yes
6138 Arguments : none
6139
6140 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6141 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006142 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006143 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6144 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006145 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006146
6147 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006148 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006149 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006150 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6151 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006152 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006153 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006154 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6155 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006156 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006157 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6158 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006159 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006160 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6161 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6162 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6163 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6164 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6165 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6166 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6167 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6168 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6169
6170 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006171 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6172 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6173 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6174 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006175
6176 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6177 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006178 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006179 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006180
6181 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6182 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6183
6184
6185option clitcpka
6186no option clitcpka
6187 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6189 yes | yes | yes | no
6190 Arguments : none
6191
6192 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6193 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006194 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006195 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6196
6197 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6198 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6199 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6200 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6201
6202 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6203 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6204 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6205 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6206 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6207
6208 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6209
6210 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6211 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6212 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6213
6214 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6215 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6216
6217 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6218
6219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006220option contstats
6221 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6223 yes | yes | yes | no
6224 Arguments : none
6225
6226 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6227 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6228 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6229 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006230 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6231 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6232 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6233 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6234 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006235
6236
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006237option dontlog-normal
6238no option dontlog-normal
6239 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6241 yes | yes | yes | no
6242 Arguments : none
6243
6244 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6245 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6246 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6247 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6248 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6249 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6250 logged.
6251
6252 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6253 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6254 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006256 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006257 logging.
6258
6259
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006260option dontlognull
6261no option dontlognull
6262 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6264 yes | yes | yes | no
6265 Arguments : none
6266
6267 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6268 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6269 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6270 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6271 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6272 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006273 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6274 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6275 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006276
6277 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006278 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006279 would not be logged.
6280
6281 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6282 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6283
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006284 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6285 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006286
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006287
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006288option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006289 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6291 yes | yes | yes | yes
6292 Arguments :
6293 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6294 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006295 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006296 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006297
6298 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6299 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6300 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6301 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6302 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6303 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6304 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006305 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6306 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6307 possible that the client has already brought one.
6308
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006309 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006310 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006311 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006312 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006313 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006314 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006315
6316 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6317 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6318 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6319 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6320 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6321 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6322 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6323
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006324 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6325 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6326 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6327 are under the control of the end-user.
6328
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006329 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006330 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6331 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006332 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6333 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6334 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006335
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006336 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006337 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6338 frontend www
6339 mode http
6340 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6341
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006342 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6343 backend www
6344 mode http
6345 option forwardfor header X-Client
6346
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006347 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006348 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006349
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006350
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006351option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6352no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6353 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6355 yes | yes | yes | no
6356 Arguments : none
6357
6358 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6359 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6360 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6361 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6362 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6363 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6364 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6365
6366 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6367 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6368 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6369 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6370 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6371 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6372 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6373 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6374 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6375 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6376
6377 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6378
6379 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6380 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6381
6382 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6383 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6384
6385
6386option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6387no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6388 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6390 yes | no | yes | yes
6391 Arguments : none
6392
6393 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6394 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6395 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6396 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6397 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6398 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6399 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6400
6401 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6402 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6403 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6404 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6405 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6406 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6407 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6408 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6409 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6410 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6411
6412 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6413
6414 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6415 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6416
6417 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6418 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6419
6420
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006421option http-buffer-request
6422no option http-buffer-request
6423 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6425 yes | yes | yes | yes
6426 Arguments : none
6427
6428 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6429 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6430 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6431 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6432 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6433 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006434 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6435 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6436 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6437 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006438
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006439 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006440
6441
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006442option http-ignore-probes
6443no option http-ignore-probes
6444 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6446 yes | yes | yes | no
6447 Arguments : none
6448
6449 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6450 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6451 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6452 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6453 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6454 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6455 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6456 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6457 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006458 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6459 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006460 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6461
6462 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6463 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6464 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6465 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6466 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6467 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6468 are often the only way to detect them.
6469
6470 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6471 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6472
6473 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6474
6475
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006476option http-keep-alive
6477no option http-keep-alive
6478 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6480 yes | yes | yes | yes
6481 Arguments : none
6482
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006483 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6484 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006485 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6486 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006487 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6488 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6489 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006490
6491 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6492 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006493 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6494 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6495 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6496 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6497 situations where this option may be useful :
6498
6499 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006500 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006501
6502 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6503 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6504
6505 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6506 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6507 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6508 request.
6509
6510 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6511 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006512 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6513 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6514 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006515
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006516 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6517 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6518 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6519 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6520 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6521 not set.
6522
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006523 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6524 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6525 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006526
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006527 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006528 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006529 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006530
6531
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006532option http-no-delay
6533no option http-no-delay
6534 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6536 yes | yes | yes | yes
6537 Arguments : none
6538
6539 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6540 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6541 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6542 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6543 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6544 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6545 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6546 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6547 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6548 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6549 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6550 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6551 affected.
6552
6553 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6554 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6555 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6556 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6557 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6558 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6559 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6560 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6561 latency environments.
6562
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006563 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6564
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006565
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006566option http-pretend-keepalive
6567no option http-pretend-keepalive
6568 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006570 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006571 Arguments : none
6572
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006573 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006574 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6575 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6576 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6577 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6578 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6579 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6580 consider the response complete.
6581
6582 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6583 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6584 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6585 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006586 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006587 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6588
6589 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6590 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6591 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6592 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6593 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6594 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6595 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6596
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006597 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6598 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6599 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6600 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6601 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6602 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006603
6604 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6605 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6606
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006607 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006608 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006609
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006610
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006611option http-server-close
6612no option http-server-close
6613 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6615 yes | yes | yes | yes
6616 Arguments : none
6617
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006618 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6619 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6620 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6621 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006622 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6623 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6624 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6625 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6626 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6627 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6628 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6629 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6630 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6631 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6632 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006633
6634 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6635 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6636 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6637 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006638 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6639 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006640
6641 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6642 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006643 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6644 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6645 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006646
6647 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6648 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6649
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006650 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6651 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006652
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006653option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006654no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006655 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 yes | yes | yes | no
6658 Arguments : none
6659
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006660 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006661 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6662 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6663 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6664 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6665 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6666 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6667
6668 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6669 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006670 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6671 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6672 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006673
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006674 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6675 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6676 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6677 front of an existing proxy.
6678
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006679 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6680
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006681 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006682
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006683option httpchk
6684option httpchk <uri>
6685option httpchk <method> <uri>
6686option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6687 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6689 yes | no | yes | yes
6690 Arguments :
6691 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6692 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6693 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6694 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6695 ones.
6696
6697 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6698 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6699 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6700
6701 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6702 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6703 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6704 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6705 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6706
6707 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6708 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6709 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6710 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6711 the lack of any response.
6712
6713 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6714
6715 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6716 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6717 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6718
6719 Examples :
6720 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6721 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6722 backend https_relay
6723 mode tcp
6724 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6725 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6726
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006727 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6728 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6729 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006730
6731
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006732option httpclose
6733no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006734 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6736 yes | yes | yes | yes
6737 Arguments : none
6738
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006739 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6740 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6741 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6742 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006743 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006744
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006745 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6746 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006747 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006748 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6749 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006750
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006751 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6752 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6753 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006754
6755 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6756 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006757 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6758 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6759 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006760
6761 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6762 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6763
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006764 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006765
6766
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006767option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006768 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006770 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006771 Arguments :
6772 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6773 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6774 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006775 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006776 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006777
6778 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6779 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6780 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6781 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6782 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6783 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6784 ports.
6785
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006786 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6787 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006788
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006789 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006791 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006792
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006793
6794option http_proxy
6795no option http_proxy
6796 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6798 yes | yes | yes | yes
6799 Arguments : none
6800
6801 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6802 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6803 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6804 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6805 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6806
6807 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6808 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006809 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6810 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006811
6812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6814
6815 Example :
6816 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6817 backend direct_forward
6818 option httpclose
6819 option http_proxy
6820
6821 See also : "option httpclose"
6822
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006823
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006824option independent-streams
6825no option independent-streams
6826 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6828 yes | yes | yes | yes
6829 Arguments : none
6830
6831 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6832 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6833 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6834 receive data or not.
6835
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006836 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006837 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6838 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6839 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6840 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6841 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6842 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6843 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6844 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6845 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6846 socket buffers.
6847
6848 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6849 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6850 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6851 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6852 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6853
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006854 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006855
6856
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006857option ldap-check
6858 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6860 yes | no | yes | yes
6861 Arguments : none
6862
6863 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6864 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6865 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6866 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6867
6868 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6869 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6870
6871 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6872 configure it.
6873
6874 Example :
6875 option ldap-check
6876
6877 See also : "option httpchk"
6878
6879
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006880option external-check
6881 Use external processes for server health checks
6882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6883 yes | no | yes | yes
6884
6885 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6886 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6887 command".
6888
6889 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6890
6891 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6892
6893
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006894option log-health-checks
6895no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006896 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6898 yes | no | yes | yes
6899 Arguments : none
6900
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006901 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6902 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6903 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006904
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006905 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6906 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6907 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6908 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6909 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6910
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006911 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006912 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006913
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006914 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6915 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6916 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006917
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006918
6919option log-separate-errors
6920no option log-separate-errors
6921 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6923 yes | yes | yes | no
6924 Arguments : none
6925
6926 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6927 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6928 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6929 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6930 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6931 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6932 provides very important information.
6933
6934 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6935 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6936 error logs.
6937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006938 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006939 logging.
6940
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006941
6942option logasap
6943no option logasap
6944 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6946 yes | yes | yes | no
6947 Arguments : none
6948
6949 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6950 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6951 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6952 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6953 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6954 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6955 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006956 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006957 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6958 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6959
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006960 Examples :
6961 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6962 mode http
6963 option httplog
6964 option logasap
6965 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6966
6967 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6968 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6969 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6970 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006972 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006973 logging.
6974
6975
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006976option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006977 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6979 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006980 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006981 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6982 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006983 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006984
6985 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6986 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006987 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006988 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6989 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6990 in the MySQL table, like this :
6991
6992 USE mysql;
6993 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6994 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6995
6996 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006997 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006998 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6999 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7000 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7001 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7002 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7003 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7004 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7005
7006 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7007 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007008
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007009 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007010
7011 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7012 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7013 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7014 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007015 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7016 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007017
7018 See also: "option httpchk"
7019
7020
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007021option nolinger
7022no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007023 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7025 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007026 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007027
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007028 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007029 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7030 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7031 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7032 connections.
7033
7034 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7035 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7036 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7037 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7038 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7039 this too.
7040
7041 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7042 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7043 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7044
7045 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7046 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7047 for servers.
7048
7049 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7050 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7051
7052
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007053option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7054 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7056 yes | yes | yes | yes
7057 Arguments :
7058 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7059 matching <network>
7060 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7061 header name.
7062
7063 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7064 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7065 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7066 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7067 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7068 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7069 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7070 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7071 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7072 possible that the client has already brought one.
7073
7074 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7075 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7076 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7077 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7078 header and requires different one.
7079
7080 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7081 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7082 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7083 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7084 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7085 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7086 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7087
7088 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7089 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7090 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7091 both are defined.
7092
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007093 Examples :
7094 # Original Destination address
7095 frontend www
7096 mode http
7097 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7098
7099 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7100 backend www
7101 mode http
7102 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7103
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007104 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007105
7106
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007107option persist
7108no option persist
7109 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7111 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007112 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007113
7114 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7115 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7116 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7117 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7118 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7119 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7120 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7121 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7122 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7123 redirected to another valid server.
7124
7125 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7126 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7127
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007128 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007129
7130
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007131option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7132 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7134 yes | no | yes | yes
7135 Arguments :
7136 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7137 PostgreSQL server.
7138
7139 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7140 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7141 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7142 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7143
7144 See also: "option httpchk"
7145
7146
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007147option prefer-last-server
7148no option prefer-last-server
7149 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7150 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7151 yes | no | yes | yes
7152 Arguments : none
7153
7154 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7155 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7156 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7157 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7158 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7159 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7160 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7161 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7162 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007163 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7164 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007165 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7166 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7167 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007168 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7169 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7170 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007171
7172 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7173 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7174
7175 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7176
7177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007178option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007179option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007180no option redispatch
7181 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7182 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7183 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007184 Arguments :
7185 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7186 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7187 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007188 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007189 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007190 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007191 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7192 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7193 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007195
7196 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7197 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7198 be able to access the service anymore.
7199
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007200 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7201 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007202
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007203 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007204 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7205 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007207 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7208 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7209
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007210 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007211
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007212
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007213option redis-check
7214 Use redis health checks for server testing
7215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7216 yes | no | yes | yes
7217 Arguments : none
7218
7219 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7220 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7221 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7222 find the "+PONG" response message.
7223
7224 Example :
7225 option redis-check
7226
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007227 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007228
7229
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007230option smtpchk
7231option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7232 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7234 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007235 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007236 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007237 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007238 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7239
7240 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7241 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7242 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7243
7244 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7245 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7246 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7247 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7248 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7249 dead server.
7250
7251 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7252 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007253 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007254 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7255
7256 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7257 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7258 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7259 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007260 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007261
7262 Example :
7263 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7264
7265 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7266
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007267
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007268option socket-stats
7269no option socket-stats
7270
7271 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7273 yes | yes | yes | no
7274
7275 Arguments : none
7276
7277
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007278option splice-auto
7279no option splice-auto
7280 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7282 yes | yes | yes | yes
7283 Arguments : none
7284
7285 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7286 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007287 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007288 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007289 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007290 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7291 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7292 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7293 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7294
7295 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7296 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7297 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7298 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7299 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7300 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7301 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7302 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7303 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7304 keyword.
7305
7306 Example :
7307 option splice-auto
7308
7309 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7310 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7311
7312 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7313 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7314
7315
7316option splice-request
7317no option splice-request
7318 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7320 yes | yes | yes | yes
7321 Arguments : none
7322
7323 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007324 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007325 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7326 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7327 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7328 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7329
7330 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7331
7332 Example :
7333 option splice-request
7334
7335 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7336 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7337
7338 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7339 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7340
7341
7342option splice-response
7343no option splice-response
7344 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7346 yes | yes | yes | yes
7347 Arguments : none
7348
7349 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007350 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007351 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7352 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7353 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7354 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7355
7356 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7357
7358 Example :
7359 option splice-response
7360
7361 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7362 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7363
7364 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7365 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7366
7367
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007368option spop-check
7369 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7371 no | no | no | yes
7372 Arguments : none
7373
7374 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7375 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7376 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7377 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7378
7379 Example :
7380 option spop-check
7381
7382 See also : "option httpchk"
7383
7384
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007385option srvtcpka
7386no option srvtcpka
7387 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7389 yes | no | yes | yes
7390 Arguments : none
7391
7392 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7393 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007394 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007395 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7396
7397 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7398 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7399 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7400 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7401
7402 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7403 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7404 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7405 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7406 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7407
7408 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7409
7410 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7411 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7412 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7413
7414 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7415 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7416
7417 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7418
7419
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007420option ssl-hello-chk
7421 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 yes | no | yes | yes
7424 Arguments : none
7425
7426 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7427 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7428 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7429 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7430 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7431 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7432 hello message.
7433
7434 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7435 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7436 messages, which is appreciable.
7437
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007438 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7439 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7440 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007441
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007442 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7443
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007444
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007445option tcp-check
7446 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7447 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7448 yes | no | yes | yes
7449
7450 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7451 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7452
7453 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7454 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7455 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7456
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007457 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007458 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7459 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7460 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7461 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7462 only.
7463
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007464 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007465 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7466 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7467 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7468 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7469
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007470 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007471 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7472 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007473 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007474 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7475 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7476 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7477 the respective protocols.
7478 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007479 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007480
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007481 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7482 script.
7483
7484 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7485 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7486 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7487 The "comment" is of course optional.
7488
7489
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007490 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007491 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007492 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007493 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007494
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007495 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007496 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007497 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007498
7499 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7500 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007501 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007502 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007503 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007504 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007505 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007506 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007507 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7508 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007509 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007510 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7511 tcp-check expect string +OK
7512
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007513 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007514 (send many headers before analyzing)
7515 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007516 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007517 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7518 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7519 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7520 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007521 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007522
7523
7524 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7525
7526
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007527option tcp-smart-accept
7528no option tcp-smart-accept
7529 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7531 yes | yes | yes | no
7532 Arguments : none
7533
7534 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7535 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7536 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7537 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7538 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7539 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7540
7541 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7542 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7543 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7544 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7545
7546 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7547 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7548 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007549 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007550
7551 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7552 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7553 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7554
7555 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7556 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7557 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7558
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007559 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7560
7561
7562option tcp-smart-connect
7563no option tcp-smart-connect
7564 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7566 yes | no | yes | yes
7567 Arguments : none
7568
7569 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7570 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7571 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7572 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7573 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7574
7575 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7576 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7577 complex.
7578
7579 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7580 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7581 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7582
7583 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7584 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7585
7586 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7587
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007588
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007589option tcpka
7590 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7592 yes | yes | yes | yes
7593 Arguments : none
7594
7595 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7596 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007597 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007598 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7599
7600 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7601 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7602 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7603 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7604
7605 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7606 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7607 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7608 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7609 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7610
7611 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7612
7613 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7614 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7615 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7616 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7617 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7618 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7619 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7620 backends.
7621
7622 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7623
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007624
7625option tcplog
7626 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007628 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007629 Arguments : none
7630
7631 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7632 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7633 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7634 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7635 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7636 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7637 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7638 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7639
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007640 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007642 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007643
7644
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007645option transparent
7646no option transparent
7647 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007649 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007650 Arguments : none
7651
7652 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7653 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7654 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7655 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7656 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7657 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7658 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7659 appropriate server.
7660
7661 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7662 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7663
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007664 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007665 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007666
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007667
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007668external-check command <command>
7669 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7671 yes | no | yes | yes
7672
7673 Arguments :
7674 <command> is the external command to run
7675
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007676 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7677
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007678 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007679
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007680 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7681 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7682 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7683 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7684 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7685 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007686
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007687 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7688
7689 Environment variables :
7690 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7691 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7692
7693 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7694
7695 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7696
7697 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7698 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7699 for a UNIX socket).
7700
7701 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7702
7703 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7704
7705 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7706
7707 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7708
7709 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7710
7711 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7712 socket).
7713
7714 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7715 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7716
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007717 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7718
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007719 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7720 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7721 failed.
7722
7723 Example :
7724 external-check command /bin/true
7725
7726 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7727
7728
7729external-check path <path>
7730 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 yes | no | yes | yes
7733
7734 Arguments :
7735 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7736
7737 The default path is "".
7738
7739 Example :
7740 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7741
7742 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7743 "external-check command"
7744
7745
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007746persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007747persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007748 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7750 yes | no | yes | yes
7751 Arguments :
7752 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007753 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7754 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007755
7756 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7757 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007758 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007759 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7760 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7761 forwarded to this server.
7762
7763 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7764 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7765 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007766 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007767 a single "listen" section.
7768
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007769 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7770 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7771 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7772
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007773 Example :
7774 listen tse-farm
7775 bind :3389
7776 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7777 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7778 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7779 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7780 persist rdp-cookie
7781 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007782 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007783 balance rdp-cookie
7784 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7785 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7786
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007787 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7788 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007789
7790
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007791rate-limit sessions <rate>
7792 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7794 yes | yes | yes | no
7795 Arguments :
7796 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7797 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7798
7799 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7800 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7801 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7802 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7803 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7804 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7805
7806 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7807 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7808 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7809 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7810
7811 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7812 listen smtp
7813 mode tcp
7814 bind :25
7815 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007816 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007817
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007818 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7819 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7820 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007821
7822 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7823
7824
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007825redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7826redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7827redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007828 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7830 no | yes | yes | yes
7831
7832 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007833 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007834
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007835 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007836 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007837 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7838 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7839 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007840
7841 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7842 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7843 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7844 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7845 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007846 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7847 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7848 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7849 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007850
7851 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7852 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7853 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7854 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7855 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7856 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007857 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007858 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007859 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7860 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7861 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007862
7863 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007864 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7865 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7866 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007867 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007868 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7869 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7870 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7871 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007872
7873 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007874 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007875
7876 - "drop-query"
7877 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7878 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7879 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7880 with a location-type redirect.
7881
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007882 - "append-slash"
7883 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7884 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7885 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7886 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7887
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007888 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7889 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7890 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7891 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7892 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7893 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7894 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7895
7896 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7897 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7898 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7899 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7900 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7901 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7902 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007903
7904 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7905 acl clear dst_port 80
7906 acl secure dst_port 8080
7907 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007908 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007909 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007910 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7911
7912 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007913 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7914 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7915 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007916 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007917
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007918 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7919 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7920 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7921
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007922 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007923 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007924
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007925 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007926 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7927 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7928 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007930 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007931
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007932
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007933retries <value>
7934 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7935 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7936 yes | no | yes | yes
7937 Arguments :
7938 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7939 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7940 default value is 3.
7941
7942 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7943 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7944 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7945
7946 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007947 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7948 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007949
7950 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7951 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7952
7953 See also : "option redispatch"
7954
7955
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007956retry-on [list of keywords]
7957 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7958 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7959 yes | no | yes | yes
7960 Arguments :
7961 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7962 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7963 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7964 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7965
7966 none never retry
7967
7968 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7969 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7970
7971 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7972 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7973 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7974 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7975 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7976 processing the request.
7977
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007978 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7979 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7980 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7981 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7982 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7983 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7984 overflow attack for example).
7985
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007986 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7987 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7988 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7989 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7990 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7991 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7992 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7993 amplify denial of service attacks.
7994
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007995 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7996 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7997 considered to be safe to retry.
7998
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007999 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8000 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8001 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8002 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8003
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008004 all-retryable-errors
8005 retry request for any error that are considered
8006 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8007 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8008 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8009
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008010 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8011 not cumulative.
8012
8013 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8014 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8015 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8016 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8017
8018 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8019 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8020 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8021 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8022 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8023 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8024 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8025 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8026 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8027 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8028 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8029 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8030
8031 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8032 should not use this directive.
8033
8034 The default is "conn-failure".
8035
8036 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8037
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008038server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008039 Declare a server in a backend
8040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8041 no | no | yes | yes
8042 Arguments :
8043 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008044 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008045 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008046
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008047 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8048 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8049 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8050 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008051 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8052 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8053 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8054 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8055 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008056 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8057 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8058 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8059 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8060 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8061 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8062 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008063 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008064 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8065 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8066 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8067 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8068 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8069 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008070 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8071 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008072 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8073 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008074
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008075 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008076 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8077 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8078 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8079 adding this value to the client's port.
8080
8081 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8082 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008083 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008084
8085 Examples :
8086 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8087 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008088 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008089 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8090 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8091 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008092
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008093 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8094 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8095 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8096 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8097 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8098
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008099 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8100 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008101
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008102server-state-file-name [<file>]
8103 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8104 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8105 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8106 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8107 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8108 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8109
8110 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8111 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8112
8113 global
8114 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8115
8116 backend bk
8117 load-server-state-from-file
8118
8119 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8120 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008121
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008122server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8123 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8124 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8126 no | no | yes | yes
8127
8128 Arguments:
8129 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8130
8131 <num | range>
8132 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8133 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8134 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8135 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8136
8137 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8138
8139 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8140
8141 <params*>
8142 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8143 keyword.
8144
8145 Examples:
8146 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8147 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8148 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8149
8150 # or
8151 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8152
8153 # would be equivalent to:
8154 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8155 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8156 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8157
8158
8159
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008160source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008161source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008162source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008163 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8165 yes | no | yes | yes
8166 Arguments :
8167 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8168 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008169
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008170 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008171 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8172 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8173 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8174 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8175 supported prefixes are :
8176 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8177 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8178 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008179 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008180 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8181 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008182
8183 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8184 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008185 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8186 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8187 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008188
8189 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8190 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8191 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8192 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8193 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8194 <addr>.
8195
8196 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8197 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8198 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8199 port.
8200
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008201 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8202 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8203 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8204 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008205 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008206 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8207 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8208 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8209 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8210 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8211 HTTP header.
8212
8213 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8214 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008215 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008216 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8217 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8218 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8219 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8220 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8221 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8222 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8223
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008224 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8225 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8226 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8227 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8228 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8229 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8230
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008231 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8232 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8233 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8234 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8235
8236 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8237 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8238 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8239 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8240 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8241 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8242
8243 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8244 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8245 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8246 there are two methods :
8247
8248 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8249 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8250 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8251 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8252 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8253 of the client ranges may be used.
8254
8255 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8256 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8257 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8258 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8259 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8260 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8261 same session.
8262
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008263 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8264 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8265 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008266 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008267
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008268 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8269
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008270 Examples :
8271 backend private
8272 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8273 source 192.168.1.200
8274
8275 backend transparent_ssl1
8276 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8277 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8278
8279 backend transparent_ssl2
8280 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8281 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8282 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8283
8284 backend transparent_ssl3
8285 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8286 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8287 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8288
8289 backend transparent_smtp
8290 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8291 # with Tproxy version 4.
8292 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8293
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008294 backend transparent_http
8295 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8296 # proxy.
8297 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008299 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008300 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8301
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008302
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008303stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8304 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008306 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008307
8308 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8309 matched.
8310
8311 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8312 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8313
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008314 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8315 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008316 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008317
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008318 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8319 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8320 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8321 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008322
8323 Example :
8324 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8325 backend stats_localhost
8326 stats enable
8327 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8328
8329 Example :
8330 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8331 backend stats_auth
8332 stats enable
8333 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8334 stats admin if TRUE
8335
8336 Example :
8337 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8338 userlist stats-auth
8339 group admin users admin
8340 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8341 group readonly users haproxy
8342 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8343
8344 backend stats_auth
8345 stats enable
8346 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8347 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8348 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8349 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8350
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008351 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8352 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8353 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008354
8355
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008356stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8357 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008359 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008360 Arguments :
8361 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8362
8363 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8364
8365 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8366 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8367 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8368 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8369 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8370 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8371
8372 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8373 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8374 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008375 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008376
8377 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8378 report using "stats scope".
8379
8380 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8381 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8382 unobvious parameters.
8383
8384 Example :
8385 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8386 backend public_www
8387 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8388 stats enable
8389 stats hide-version
8390 stats scope .
8391 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008392 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008393 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8394 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8395
8396 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8397 backend private_monitoring
8398 stats enable
8399 stats uri /admin?stats
8400 stats refresh 5s
8401
8402 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8403
8404
8405stats enable
8406 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008408 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008409 Arguments : none
8410
8411 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8412 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8413 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8414 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8415 - stats auth : no authentication
8416 - stats scope : no restriction
8417
8418 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8419 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8420 unobvious parameters.
8421
8422 Example :
8423 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8424 backend public_www
8425 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8426 stats enable
8427 stats hide-version
8428 stats scope .
8429 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008430 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008431 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8432 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8433
8434 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8435 backend private_monitoring
8436 stats enable
8437 stats uri /admin?stats
8438 stats refresh 5s
8439
8440 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8441
8442
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008443stats hide-version
8444 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008446 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008447 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008448
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008449 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8450 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8451 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8452 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8453 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8454 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008456 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8457 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8458 unobvious parameters.
8459
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008460 Example :
8461 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8462 backend public_www
8463 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008464 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008465 stats hide-version
8466 stats scope .
8467 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008468 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008469 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8470 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008471
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008472 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8473 backend private_monitoring
8474 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008475 stats uri /admin?stats
8476 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008477
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008478 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008479
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008480
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008481stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8482 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8483 Access control for statistics
8484
8485 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8486 no | no | yes | yes
8487
8488 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8489 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8490 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8491 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8492 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8493 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8494
8495 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8496 instance.
8497
8498 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8499 about ACL usage.
8500
8501
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008502stats realm <realm>
8503 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008505 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008506 Arguments :
8507 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8508 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8509 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8510
8511 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8512 using a backslash ('\').
8513
8514 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8515 only related to authentication.
8516
8517 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8518 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8519 unobvious parameters.
8520
8521 Example :
8522 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8523 backend public_www
8524 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8525 stats enable
8526 stats hide-version
8527 stats scope .
8528 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008529 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008530 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8531 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8532
8533 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8534 backend private_monitoring
8535 stats enable
8536 stats uri /admin?stats
8537 stats refresh 5s
8538
8539 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8540
8541
8542stats refresh <delay>
8543 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008545 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008546 Arguments :
8547 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8548 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8549 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8550 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8551 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8552 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8553
8554 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8555 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8556 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8557 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8558
8559 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8560 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8561 unobvious parameters.
8562
8563 Example :
8564 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8565 backend public_www
8566 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8567 stats enable
8568 stats hide-version
8569 stats scope .
8570 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008571 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008572 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8573 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8574
8575 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8576 backend private_monitoring
8577 stats enable
8578 stats uri /admin?stats
8579 stats refresh 5s
8580
8581 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8582
8583
8584stats scope { <name> | "." }
8585 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008587 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008588 Arguments :
8589 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8590 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8591 section in which the statement appears.
8592
8593 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8594 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8595 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8596 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8597 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8598 exists.
8599
8600 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8601 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8602 unobvious parameters.
8603
8604 Example :
8605 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8606 backend public_www
8607 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8608 stats enable
8609 stats hide-version
8610 stats scope .
8611 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008612 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008613 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8614 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8615
8616 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8617 backend private_monitoring
8618 stats enable
8619 stats uri /admin?stats
8620 stats refresh 5s
8621
8622 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8623
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008624
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008625stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008626 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008628 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008629
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008630 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008631 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8632
8633 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8634 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8635
8636 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8637 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008638 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008639
8640 Example :
8641 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8642 backend private_monitoring
8643 stats enable
8644 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8645 stats uri /admin?stats
8646 stats refresh 5s
8647
8648 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8649 global section.
8650
8651
8652stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008653 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8655 yes | yes | yes | yes
8656 Arguments : none
8657
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008658 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008659 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8660 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8661 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8662 - IP (socket, server)
8663 - cookie (backend, server)
8664
8665 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8666 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008667 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008668
8669 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8670
8671
8672stats show-node [ <name> ]
8673 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008675 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008676 Arguments:
8677 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8678 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8679
8680 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8681 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008682 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008683
8684 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8685 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8686 unobvious parameters.
8687
8688 Example:
8689 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8690 backend private_monitoring
8691 stats enable
8692 stats show-node Europe-1
8693 stats uri /admin?stats
8694 stats refresh 5s
8695
8696 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8697 section.
8698
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008699
8700stats uri <prefix>
8701 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008703 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008704 Arguments :
8705 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8706 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8707 query string.
8708
8709 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8710 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8711 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8712 possible to reach it in the application.
8713
8714 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008715 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008716 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8717 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8718 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8719 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8720
8721 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8722 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8723 an address or a port to statistics only.
8724
8725 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8726 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8727 unobvious parameters.
8728
8729 Example :
8730 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8731 backend public_www
8732 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8733 stats enable
8734 stats hide-version
8735 stats scope .
8736 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008737 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008738 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8739 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8740
8741 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8742 backend private_monitoring
8743 stats enable
8744 stats uri /admin?stats
8745 stats refresh 5s
8746
8747 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8748
8749
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008750stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8751 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008753 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008754
8755 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008756 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008757 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008758 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008759 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8760
8761 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8762 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8763 the "stick-table" statement.
8764
8765 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8766 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8767 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8768 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8769 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8770
8771 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8772 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8773 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8774 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8775 transformation rules.
8776
8777 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8778 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8779 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8780 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8781 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8782 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8783 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8784
8785 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8786 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8787 ACL based conditions.
8788
8789 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8790 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8791 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8792 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8793
8794 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8795 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8796 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8797 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8798
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008799 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8800 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008801 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008802
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008803 Example :
8804 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8805 # last 30 minutes
8806 backend pop
8807 mode tcp
8808 balance roundrobin
8809 stick store-request src
8810 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8811 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8812 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8813
8814 backend smtp
8815 mode tcp
8816 balance roundrobin
8817 stick match src table pop
8818 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8819 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8820
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008821 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008822 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008823
8824
8825stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8826 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8828 no | no | yes | yes
8829
8830 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8831 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8832 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8833 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8834
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008835 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8836 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008837 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008838
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008839 Examples :
8840 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008841 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008842
8843 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8844 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8845 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8846
8847
8848 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8849 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8850 backend http
8851 mode http
8852 balance roundrobin
8853 stick on src table https
8854 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8855 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8856 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8857
8858 backend https
8859 mode tcp
8860 balance roundrobin
8861 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8862 stick on src
8863 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8864 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8865
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008866 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008867
8868
8869stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8870 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8872 no | no | yes | yes
8873
8874 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008875 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008876 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008877 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008878 server is selected.
8879
8880 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8881 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8882 the "stick-table" statement.
8883
8884 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8885 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8886 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8887 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8888 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8889 address.
8890
8891 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8892 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8893 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8894 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8895 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8896 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8897 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8898 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8899 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8900 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8901
8902 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8903 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8904 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8905 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8906 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8907 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8908 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8909
8910 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8911 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8912 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8913 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8914
8915 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8916 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8917 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8918 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8919 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8920 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008921 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8922 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8923 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8924 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8925 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8926 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008927
8928 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8929 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8930 the request.
8931
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008932 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8933 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008934 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008935
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008936 Example :
8937 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8938 # last 30 minutes
8939 backend pop
8940 mode tcp
8941 balance roundrobin
8942 stick store-request src
8943 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8944 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8945 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8946
8947 backend smtp
8948 mode tcp
8949 balance roundrobin
8950 stick match src table pop
8951 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8952 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8953
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008954 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008955 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008956
8957
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008958stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008959 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8960 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008961 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008963 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008964
8965 Arguments :
8966 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8967 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8968 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8969 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8970
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008971 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8972 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8973 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8974 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8975
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008976 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8977 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8978 instance.
8979
8980 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8981 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8982 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8983 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8984 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8985 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008986 to 32 characters.
8987
8988 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8989 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8990 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008991 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008992 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8993 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008994
8995 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008996 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8997 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008998 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8999 increase.
9000
9001 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009002 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9003 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9004 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009005
9006 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9007 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9008 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9009 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009010 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009011 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9012 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9013 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9014 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9015 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9016 parameter (see below).
9017
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009018 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9019 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9020 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9021 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9022 soft restart.
9023
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009024 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9025 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009026
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009027 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9028 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9029 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9030 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009031 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009032 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009033 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9034 if not expiration delay is specified.
9035
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009036 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9037 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9038 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9039 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009040 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9041 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9042 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9043 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9044 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9045 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9046 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9047 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9048 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9049 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9050 types and their arguments.
9051
9052 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9053 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9054 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9055 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9056
9057 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9058 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9059 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009060 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009061
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009062 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9063 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9064 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009065 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009066 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009067 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009068
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009069 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9070 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9071 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9072 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9073
9074 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9075 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9076 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9077 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9078 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9079 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9080
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009081 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9082 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9083 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9084 they were received.
9085
9086 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9087 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9088 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9089 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9090 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9091
9092 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9093 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9094 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9095 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9096 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9097
9098 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9099 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9100 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9101
9102 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9103 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9104 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9105 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9106 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9107
9108 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9109 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9110 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9111 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9112 the client side.
9113
9114 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9115 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9116 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9117 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9118 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9119 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9120 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9121
9122 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9123 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9124 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9125 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9126 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9127 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009128 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009129
9130 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9131 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9132 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9133 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9134 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9135 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9136
9137 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009138 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009139 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9140 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9141
9142 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9143 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9144 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9145 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9146 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9147 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9148 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9149 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9150 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9151 recommended for better fairness.
9152
9153 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009154 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009155 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9156 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9157
9158 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9159 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9160 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9161 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9162 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9163 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9164 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9165 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9166 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9167 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009168
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009169 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9170 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009171 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9172 reference it.
9173
9174 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9175 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009176 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9177 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9178 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009179
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009180 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9181 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9182 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9183 something that can be ignored.
9184
9185 Example:
9186 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9187 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9188 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9189 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9190
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009191 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009192 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009193
9194
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009195stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009196 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9198 no | no | yes | yes
9199
9200 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009201 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009202 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009203 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009204 server is selected.
9205
9206 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9207 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9208 the "stick-table" statement.
9209
9210 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9211 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9212 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9213 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9214
9215 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9216 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9217 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9218 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9219 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9220 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009221 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009222 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9223 rules.
9224
9225 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9226 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9227 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9228 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9229 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9230 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9231 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9232
9233 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9234 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9235 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9236 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9237
9238 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9239 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9240 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9241 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9242 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9243 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009244 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9245 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9246 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9247 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9248 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9249 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9250 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9251 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9252 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009253
9254 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9255
9256 Example :
9257 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9258 backend https
9259 mode tcp
9260 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009261 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009262 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009263
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009264 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9265 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9266
9267 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9268 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9269 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9270
9271 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9272 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009273
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009274 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9275 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9276 # at offset 44.
9277
9278 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9279 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9280
9281 # Learn on response if server hello.
9282 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009283
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009284 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9285 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9286
9287 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9288 extraction.
9289
9290
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009291tcp-check connect [params*]
9292 Opens a new connection
9293 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9294 no | no | yes | yes
9295
9296 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9297 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9298 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9299
9300 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9301 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9302 of the sequence.
9303
9304 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9305 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9306 do.
9307
9308 Parameters :
9309 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9310 use the TCP connection.
9311
9312 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9313 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9314 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9315
9316 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9317
9318 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9319
9320 Examples:
9321 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9322 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9323 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9324 option tcp-check
9325 tcp-check connect
9326 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9327 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9328 tcp-check send \r\n
9329 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9330 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9331 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9332 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9333 tcp-check send \r\n
9334 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9335 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9336
9337 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9338 option tcp-check
9339 tcp-check connect port 110
9340 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9341 tcp-check connect port 143
9342 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9343 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9344
9345 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9346
9347
9348tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009349 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009350 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9351 no | no | yes | yes
9352
9353 Arguments :
9354 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9355 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9356 binary.
9357 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9358 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9359 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9360
9361 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9362 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9363 with the usual backslash ('\').
9364 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009365 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009366 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9367 used upper or lower case.
9368
9369
9370 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9371
9372 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9373 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9374 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9375 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9376 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9377 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9378 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9379 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9380
9381 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9382 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9383 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9384 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9385 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9386 expression.
9387
9388 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9389 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9390 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9391 this exact hexadecimal string.
9392 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9393
9394 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9395 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9396 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9397 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9398 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9399 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9400 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9401 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9402 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9403 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9404 the null character.
9405
9406 Examples :
9407 # perform a POP check
9408 option tcp-check
9409 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9410
9411 # perform an IMAP check
9412 option tcp-check
9413 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9414
9415 # look for the redis master server
9416 option tcp-check
9417 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009418 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009419 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9420 tcp-check expect string role:master
9421 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9422 tcp-check expect string +OK
9423
9424
9425 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9426 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9427
9428
9429tcp-check send <data>
9430 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9432 no | no | yes | yes
9433
9434 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9435 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9436
9437 Examples :
9438 # look for the redis master server
9439 option tcp-check
9440 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9441 tcp-check expect string role:master
9442
9443 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9444 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9445
9446
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009447tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9448 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009449 tcp health check
9450 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9451 no | no | yes | yes
9452
9453 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9454 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009455 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009456 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9457 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9458 hexadecimal string.
9459 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9460
9461 Examples :
9462 # redis check in binary
9463 option tcp-check
9464 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9465 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9466
9467
9468 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9469 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9470
9471
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009472tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9473 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9475 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009476 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009477 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9478 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009479
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009480 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009481
9482 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9483 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009484 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9485 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9486 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9487 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9488 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9489 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009491 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9492 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9493 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9494 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009495
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009496 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009497 - accept :
9498 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9499 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9500 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009501
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009502 - reject :
9503 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9504 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9505 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9506 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9507 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9508 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9509 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9510 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9511 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9512 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9513 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009514 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009515
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009516 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9517 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9518 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9519 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9520 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9521 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9522 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9523 hosts.
9524
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009525 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9526 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9527 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9528 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9529 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9530 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9531 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9532 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9533
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009534 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9535 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9536 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9537 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9538 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9539 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9540 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9541 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9542 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009543 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9544 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009545
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009546 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009547 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009548 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9549 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9550 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009551 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009552 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9553 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9554 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9555 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9556 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9557 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9558 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9559 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009560
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009561 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009562 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009563 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009564 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009565 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9566 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9567 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009568
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009569 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9570 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9571 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9572 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009573
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009574 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9575 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9576 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9577 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9578 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009579 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9580 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9581 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9582 layer7 information is extracted.
9583
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009584 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9585 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9586 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9587 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9588 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009589
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009590 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9591 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9592 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9593 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9594
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009595 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9596 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9597 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9598 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9599
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009600 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9601 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9602 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9603 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9604 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009605
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009606 - set-src <expr> :
9607 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9608 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9609 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009610 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009611
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009612 Arguments:
9613 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9614 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009615
9616 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009617 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9618
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009619 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9620 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009621
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009622 - set-src-port <expr> :
9623 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9624 expression.
9625
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009626 Arguments:
9627 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9628 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009629
9630 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009631 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9632
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009633 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9634 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9635 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009636
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009637 - set-dst <expr> :
9638 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9639 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9640 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9641 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9642 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9643
9644 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9645 followed by some converters.
9646
9647 Example:
9648
9649 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9650 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9651
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009652 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9653 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9654
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009655 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9656 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9657 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9658 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9659
9660
9661 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9662 followed by some converters.
9663
9664 Example:
9665
9666 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9667
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009668 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9669 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9670 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9671
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009672 - "silent-drop" :
9673 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009674 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009675 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9676 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9677 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9678 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9679 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009680 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9681 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009682 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9683 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009684 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009685 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9686 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9687 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9688 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9689
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009690 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9691 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9692 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009693
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009694 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9695 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9696 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009697
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009698 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009699 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009700 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009701
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009702 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9703 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9704 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009705
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009706 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009707 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9708 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009709
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009710 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9711
9712 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9713
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009714 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9715
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009716 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009717
9718
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009719tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9720 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009722 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009723 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009724 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9725 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009726
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009727 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009728
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009729 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009730 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9731 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9732 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9733 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009734
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009735 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9736 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9737 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9738 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009739 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9740 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9741 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9742 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9743 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9744 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009745 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009746 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009747
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009748 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9749 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9750 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9751 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009752
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009753 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009754 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009755 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009756 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9757 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009758 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009759 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009760 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009761 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009762 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009763 - set-dst <expr>
9764 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009765 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009766 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009767 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009768 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009769 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009770
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009771 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9772 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009773 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9774 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009775
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009776 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9777 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9778 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9779 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9780 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9781 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009783 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009784 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9785 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009786
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009787 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009788 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9789 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9790 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9791 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009792 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9793 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9794 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009795
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009796 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009797 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9798 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9799 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009800
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009801 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9802 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9803
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009804 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009805 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9806 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009807
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009808 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9809 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009810 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009811 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9812 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009813 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009814 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009815 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009816 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9817 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009818 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009819 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9820 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009821
9822 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9823 followed by some converters.
9824
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009825 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9826 <var-name>.
9827
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009828 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9829 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9830 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9831 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9832 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9833
9834 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9835 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9836 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9837 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9838 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9839 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9840 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9841 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9842 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9843 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9844 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9845
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009846 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9847 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9848 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9849 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9850 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9851
9852 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9853
9854 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9855
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009856 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9857 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9858 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9859 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9860 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9861 evaluated.
9862
9863 Example:
9864 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9865
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009866 Example:
9867
9868 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009869 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009870
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009871 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009872 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9873 # and reject everything else.
9874 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9875 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009876 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009877 tcp-request content reject
9878
9879 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009880 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9881 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9882 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009883 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009884
9885 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9886 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9887 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009888 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009889 tcp-request content reject
9890
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009891 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009892 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009893 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009894 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009895 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9896 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009897
9898 Example:
9899 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9900 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009901 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009903 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009904 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009905
9906 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009907 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009908 # protecting all our sites
9909 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009910 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9911 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009912 ...
9913 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9914
9915 backend http_dynamic
9916 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009917 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009918 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009919 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009920 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009921 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009922 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009924 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009925
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009926 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9927 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009928
9929
9930tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9931 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009933 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009934 Arguments :
9935 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9936 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9937 as explained at the top of this document.
9938
9939 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9940 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9941 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9942 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9943 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9944
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009945 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9946 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9947 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9948 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9949
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009950 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9951 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009952 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009953 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009954 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9955 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9956 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9957 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009958
9959 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9960 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9961 it pass through unaffected.
9962
9963 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9964 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9965 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009966 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009967 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9968 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009969 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9970 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9971 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009972
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009973 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009974 "timeout client".
9975
9976
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009977tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9978 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9980 no | no | yes | yes
9981 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009982 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9983 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009984
9985 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9986
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009987 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009988 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9989 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009990 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9991 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009992
9993 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9994
9995 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9996 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9997 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9998 inserted.
9999
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010000 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010001 - accept :
10002 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10003 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10004 the rules evaluation.
10005
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010006 - close :
10007 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10008 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10009 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10010 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10011 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10012 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010013 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010014 protocols.
10015
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010016 - reject :
10017 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10018 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010019 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010020
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010021 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10022 Sets a variable.
10023
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010024 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10025 Unsets a variable.
10026
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010027 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10028 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10029 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10030 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10031
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010032 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10033 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10034 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10035 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10036
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010037 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10038 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10039 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10040 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10041 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010042
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010043 - "silent-drop" :
10044 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010045 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010046 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10047 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10048 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10049 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10050 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010051 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10052 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010053 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10054 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010055 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010056 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10057 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10058 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10059 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10060
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010061 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10062 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10063
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010064 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10065 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10066 for changing the default action to a reject.
10067
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010068 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10069 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10070 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10071 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010072 period.
10073
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010074 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10075 declared inline.
10076
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010077 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10078 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010079 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010080 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10081 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010082 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010083 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010084 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010085 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10086 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010087 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010088 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10089 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010090
10091 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10092 followed by some converters.
10093
10094 Example:
10095
10096 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10097
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010098 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10099 <var-name>.
10100
10101 Example:
10102
10103 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10104
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010105 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10106 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10107 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10108 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10109 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10110
10111 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10112
10113 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10114
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010115 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10116
10117 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10118
10119
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010120tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10121 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10123 no | yes | yes | no
10124 Arguments :
10125 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10126 below.
10127
10128 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010130 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010131 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10132 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10133 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10134 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10135 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10136 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10137 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010138 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010139 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10140 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10141 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10142 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10143 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10144 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10145 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10146 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10147 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10148 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10149 instead.
10150
10151 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10152 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10153 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10154 rules which may be inserted.
10155
10156 Several types of actions are supported :
10157 - accept : the request is accepted
10158 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10159 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10160 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010161 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010162 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010163 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010164 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010165 - silent-drop
10166
10167 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10168 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10169 sections for a complete description.
10170
10171 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10172 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10173 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10174
10175 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10176 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10177 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10178 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10179 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10180
10181 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10182 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10183
10184 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10185 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10186 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10187
10188 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10189 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10190 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10191
10192 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10193 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10194 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10195
10196 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10197 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10198 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10199
10200 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10201
10202 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10203
10204
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010205tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10206 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10208 no | no | yes | yes
10209 Arguments :
10210 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10212 as explained at the top of this document.
10213
10214 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10215
10216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010217timeout check <timeout>
10218 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10219 established.
10220
10221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10222 yes | no | yes | yes
10223 Arguments:
10224 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10225 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10226 as explained at the top of this document.
10227
10228 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10229 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010230 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010231 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010232 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10233 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10234 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010235
10236 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10237 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10238
10239 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10240 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010241 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010242
10243 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10244 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10245 forget about it.
10246
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010247 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10248 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010249
10250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010251timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010252 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10254 yes | yes | yes | no
10255 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010256 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010257 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10258 as explained at the top of this document.
10259
10260 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10261 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10262 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010263 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10264 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10265 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10266 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010267 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10268 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10269 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010270 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010271 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010272 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10273 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010274 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10275 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010276
10277 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10278 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10279 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10280 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010281 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010282 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10283
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010284 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010285
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010286 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010287
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010288
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010289timeout client-fin <timeout>
10290 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10292 yes | yes | yes | no
10293 Arguments :
10294 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10295 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10296 as explained at the top of this document.
10297
10298 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10299 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10300 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10301 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10302 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10303 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10304 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010305 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10306 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10307 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010308
10309 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10310 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10311 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10312
10313 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10314
10315
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010316timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010317 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10319 yes | no | yes | yes
10320 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010321 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010322 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10323 as explained at the top of this document.
10324
10325 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010326 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010327 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010328 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010329 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10330 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010331
10332 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10333 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10334 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10335 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010336 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010337 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10338
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010339 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010341
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010342timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10343 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10345 yes | yes | yes | yes
10346 Arguments :
10347 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10348 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10349 as explained at the top of this document.
10350
10351 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10352 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10353 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10354 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10355 once the request has started to present itself.
10356
10357 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10358 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10359 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10360 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10361 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10362
10363 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10364 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10365 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10366 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10367
10368 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10369 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010370 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010371 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10372 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010373 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010374
10375 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10376 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10377 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10378 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10379
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010380 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10381 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010382 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10383
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010384 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10385
10386
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010387timeout http-request <timeout>
10388 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010390 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010391 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010392 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010393 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10394 as explained at the top of this document.
10395
10396 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10397 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10398 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10399 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10400 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10401 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10402 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010403 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10404 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10405 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10406 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010407 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010408 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10409 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010410
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010411 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10412 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10413 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10414 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10415 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010416 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010417
10418 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10419 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010420 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010421 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10422 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10423
10424 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010425 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10426 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10427 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010428
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010429 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010430 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010431
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010432
10433timeout queue <timeout>
10434 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10436 yes | no | yes | yes
10437 Arguments :
10438 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10439 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10440 as explained at the top of this document.
10441
10442 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10443 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10444 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10445 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10446 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10447
10448 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10449 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10450 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10451 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10452
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010453 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010454
10455
10456timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010457 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10459 yes | no | yes | yes
10460 Arguments :
10461 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10462 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10463 as explained at the top of this document.
10464
10465 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10466 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10467 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10468 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10469 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10470 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10471 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10472
10473 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10474 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10475 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10476 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10477 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010478 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010479 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010480 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10481 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010482 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10483 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010484
10485 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10486 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10487 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10488 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010489 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010490 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10491
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010492 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010493
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010494
10495timeout server-fin <timeout>
10496 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10498 yes | no | yes | yes
10499 Arguments :
10500 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10501 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10502 as explained at the top of this document.
10503
10504 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10505 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10506 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10507 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10508 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10509 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10510 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10511 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10512 situations, it should not be needed.
10513
10514 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10515 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10516 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10517
10518 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10519
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010520
10521timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010522 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10524 yes | yes | yes | yes
10525 Arguments :
10526 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10527 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10528 as explained at the top of this document.
10529
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010530 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10531 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10532 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010533
10534 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10535 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10536 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10537 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010538 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010539
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010540 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010541
10542
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010543timeout tunnel <timeout>
10544 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10546 yes | no | yes | yes
10547 Arguments :
10548 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10549 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10550 as explained at the top of this document.
10551
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010552 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010553 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10554 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10555 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010556 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10557 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010558 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10559 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10560 specified.
10561
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010562 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10563 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10564 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10565 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10566 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10567 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10568 state.
10569
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010570 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10571 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10572 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10573 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010574 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010575
10576 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10577 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10578 forget about it.
10579
10580 Example :
10581 defaults http
10582 option http-server-close
10583 timeout connect 5s
10584 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010585 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010586 timeout server 30s
10587 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10588
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010589 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010590
10591
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010592transparent (deprecated)
10593 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010595 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010596 Arguments : none
10597
10598 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10599 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10600 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10601 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10602 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10603 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10604 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10605 appropriate server.
10606
10607 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10608
10609 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10610 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10611
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010612 See also: "option transparent"
10613
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010614unique-id-format <string>
10615 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10617 yes | yes | yes | no
10618 Arguments :
10619 <string> is a log-format string.
10620
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010621 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10622 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10623 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10624 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010625
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010626 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10627 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10628 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10629 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10630 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10631 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10632 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10633 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010634
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010635 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10636 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010637
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010638 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010639
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010640 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010641
10642 will generate:
10643
10644 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10645
10646 See also: "unique-id-header"
10647
10648unique-id-header <name>
10649 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10651 yes | yes | yes | no
10652 Arguments :
10653 <name> is the name of the header.
10654
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010655 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10656 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010657
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010658 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010659
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010660 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010661 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10662
10663 will generate:
10664
10665 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10666
10667 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010668
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010669use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010670 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10672 no | yes | yes | no
10673 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010674 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10675 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010676
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010677 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10678 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010679
10680 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10681 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10682 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010683 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010684 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010685 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10686 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010687
10688 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10689 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10690 assign the backend.
10691
10692 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10693 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10694 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10695 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10696 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10697 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10698
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010699 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010700 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010701 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10702 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10703 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10704
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010705 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10706 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10707 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10708 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10709 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10710 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10711 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10712 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10713 cannot be forced from the request.
10714
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010715 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010716 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10717 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10718
10719 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10720 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010721
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010722use-fcgi-app <name>
10723 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10725 no | no | yes | yes
10726 Arguments :
10727 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10728
10729 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010730
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010731use-server <server> if <condition>
10732use-server <server> unless <condition>
10733 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10735 no | no | yes | yes
10736 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010737 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010738
10739 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10740
10741 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10742 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10743 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10744
10745 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10746 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10747 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10748 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10749 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10750 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10751 matches will assign the server.
10752
10753 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10754 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10755 with the next rules until one matches.
10756
10757 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10758 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10759 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10760 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10761
10762 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10763 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10764 stripped.
10765
10766 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10767 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10768 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10769 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10770
10771 Example :
10772 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10773 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10774 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10775 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10776 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10777 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010778 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010779 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10780 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10781
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010782 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010783
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010784
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107855. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010786--------------------------
10787
10788The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10789depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10790settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10791written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10792described in this section.
10793
10794
107955.1. Bind options
10796-----------------
10797
10798The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10799as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10800no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10801parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10802while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10803provided immediately after the setting name.
10804
10805The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10806
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010807accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10808 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10809 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10810 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10811 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10812 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10813 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10814 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10815 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10816 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010817 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10818 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10819 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010820
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010821accept-proxy
10822 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010823 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10824 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010825 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10826 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10827 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10828 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010829 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010830 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10831 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010832 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10833 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010834
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010835allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010836 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010837 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010838 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010839 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10840 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010841
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010842alpn <protocols>
10843 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10844 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10845 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010846 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010847 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010848 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10849 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10850 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10851 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10852 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10853 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10854 preference, like below :
10855
10856 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010857
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010858backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010859 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010860 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10861
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010862curves <curves>
10863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10864 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10865 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10866 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10867 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10868 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10869
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010870ecdhe <named curve>
10871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010872 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10873 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010874
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010875ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10877 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10878 client's certificate.
10879
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010880ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10882 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10883 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10884 error is ignored.
10885
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010886ca-sign-file <cafile>
10887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10888 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10889 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10890 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10891 'generate-certificates' for details.
10892
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010893ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10895 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10896 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10897 'generate-certificates' for details.
10898
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010899ciphers <ciphers>
10900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10901 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010902 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010903 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010904 information and recommendations see e.g.
10905 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10906 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10907 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10908
10909ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10911 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10912 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10913 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010914 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10915 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010916
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010917crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010918 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10919 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10920 to verify client's certificate.
10921
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010922crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10924 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10925 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10926 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10927 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10928 file.
10929
10930 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10931 are loaded.
10932
10933 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010934 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010935 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10936 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10937 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10938 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010939 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10940 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010941 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010942
10943 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10944 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10945 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10946 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010947 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10948 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010949
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010950 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010951
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010952 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010953 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010954 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10955 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010956 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10957 clients).
10958
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010959 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10960 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10961 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10962 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10963 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10964 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10965 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10966 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10967 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10968 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10969 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10970 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10971 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10972
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010973 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10974 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10975 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10976 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10977 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10978
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010979 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10980 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10981 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10982 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010983
10984 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10985 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10986 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10987 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10988 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10989 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10990 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10991 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10992 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10993
10994 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10995
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010996 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010997 a cert bundle.
10998
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010999 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011000 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11001 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11002 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11003 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11004 provide multi-cert support.
11005
11006 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11007
11008 Filename | CN | SAN
11009 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11010 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011011 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011012 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11013 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11014
11015 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11016 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11017 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11018 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011019 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11020 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11021 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011022
11023 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11024 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11025
11026 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11027 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11028 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11029
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011030crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011032 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011033 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011034 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011035
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011036crt-list <file>
11037 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011038 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11039 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011040
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011041 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11042
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011043 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11044 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011045 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011046 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011047
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011048 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11049 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11050 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11051 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11052 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11053 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11054 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11055 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011056
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011057 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011058 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011059 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11060 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11061 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011062
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011063 crt-list file example:
11064 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011065 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011066 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011067 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011068
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011069defer-accept
11070 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11071 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11072 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011073 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011074 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11075 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11076 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11077 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11078 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11079 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11080 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11081
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011082expose-fd listeners
11083 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11084 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011085 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11086 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011087 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011088
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011089force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011090 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011091 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011092 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011093 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011094
11095force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011096 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011097 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011098 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011099
11100force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011101 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011102 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011103 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011104
11105force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011106 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011107 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011108 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011109
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011110force-tlsv13
11111 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11112 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011113 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011114
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011115generate-certificates
11116 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11117 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11118 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11119 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11120 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11121 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11122 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11123 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11124 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11125 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11126 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11127
11128 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11129 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011130 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011131 certificate is used many times.
11132
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011133gid <gid>
11134 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11135 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11136 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11137 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11138 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11139
11140group <group>
11141 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11142 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11143 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11144 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11145 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11146
11147id <id>
11148 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11149 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11150 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11151 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11152
11153interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011154 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11155 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11156 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11157 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11158 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11159 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011160 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11161 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11162 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11163 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11164 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11165 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011166
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011167level <level>
11168 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11169 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11170 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011171 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011172 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11173 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11174 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011175 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011176 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011177 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011178 all counters).
11179
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011180severity-output <format>
11181 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11182 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11183 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11184 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11185 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11186 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11187 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11188 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11189 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11190 rfc5424 convention.
11191
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011192maxconn <maxconn>
11193 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11194 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11195 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11196 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11197 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11198 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11199 eat all memory.
11200
11201mode <mode>
11202 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11203 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11204 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11205 UNIX sockets.
11206
11207mss <maxseg>
11208 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11209 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11210 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11211 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11212 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11213 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11214 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11215 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11216 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11217 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11218 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11219
11220name <name>
11221 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11222 page.
11223
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011224namespace <name>
11225 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11226 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11227 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11228 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11229
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011230nice <nice>
11231 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11232 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11233 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11234 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11235 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11236 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11237 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11238 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11239 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11240 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11241 one for an RDP socket.
11242
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011243no-ca-names
11244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11245 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11246
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011247no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011248 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011249 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011250 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011251 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011252 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11253 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011254
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011255no-tls-tickets
11256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11257 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11258 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011259 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11260 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011261
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011262no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011264 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011265 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011266 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011267 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11268 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011269
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011270no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011272 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011273 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011274 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011275 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11276 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011277
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011278no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011280 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011281 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011282 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011283 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11284 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011285
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011286no-tlsv13
11287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11288 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11289 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11290 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011291 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11292 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011293
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011294npn <protocols>
11295 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11296 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11297 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011298 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011299 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011300 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11301 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11302 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11303 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11304 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011305
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011306prefer-client-ciphers
11307 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11308 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11309 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011310 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11311 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11312 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011313
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011314process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011315 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011316 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011317 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011318 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11319 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11320 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11321 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011322 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011323 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11324 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11325 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11326 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11327 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011328
11329 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11330
11331 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11332 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11333 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11334 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11335 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11336 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11337 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11338 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011339
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011340proto <name>
11341 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11342 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11343 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11344 in haproxy -vv.
11345 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11346 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011347 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011348 h2" on the bind line.
11349
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011350ssl
11351 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011352 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011353 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11354 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011355 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11356 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011357
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011358ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11359 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11360 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11361 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11362
11363ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11364 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11365 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11366 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11367
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011368strict-sni
11369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11370 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11371 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11372 See the "crt" option for more information.
11373
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011374tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011375 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011376 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11377 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011378 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011379 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11380 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11381 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11382 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11383 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11384 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11385 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11386
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011387tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011388 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011389 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11390 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11391 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11392 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11393 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11394 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11395 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011396 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11397 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11398 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011399
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011400tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11401 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011402 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11403 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11404 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11405 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11406 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11407 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11408 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11409 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11410 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11411 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011412 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11413 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11414
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011415transparent
11416 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11417 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11418 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11419 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11420 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11421 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11422 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11423 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11424 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11425 so check for support with your vendor.
11426
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011427v4v6
11428 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11429 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11430 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11431 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011432 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011433
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011434v6only
11435 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11436 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11437 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011438 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11439 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011440
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011441uid <uid>
11442 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11443 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11444 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11445 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11446 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11447
11448user <user>
11449 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11450 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11451 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11452 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11453 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11454
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011455verify [none|optional|required]
11456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11457 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11458 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11459 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11460 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011461 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11462 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11463 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11464 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011465
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114665.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011467------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011469The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11470which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11471arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11472settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11473after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11474Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11475address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011477 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011478 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011479
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011480Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11481keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011483The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011484
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011485addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011486 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011487 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11488 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11489 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11490 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11491 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011492
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011493agent-check
11494 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011495 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011496 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11497 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11498 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011499
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011500 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011501 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011502 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11503 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11504 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011505
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011506 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11507 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11508 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11509 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11510 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011511
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011512 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011513 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011514
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011515 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11516 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11517 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011518
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011519 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11520 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11521 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011522
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011523 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11524 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11525 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11526 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11527 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011528 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011529 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011530
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011531 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11532 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011533
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011534 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11535 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11536 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11537 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11538 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11539 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11540 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11541 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11542 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011543
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011544 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11545 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011546 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11547 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11548 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011549 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011550
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011551 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011552 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011553
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011554agent-send <string>
11555 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11556 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11557 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11558 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11559 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11560
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011561agent-inter <delay>
11562 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11563 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11564
11565 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11566 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11567 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11568 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11569 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11570 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11571 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11572 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11573 of backends use the same servers.
11574
11575 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11576
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011577agent-addr <addr>
11578 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11579
11580 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11581 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11582 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11583 hostname, it will be resolved.
11584
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011585agent-port <port>
11586 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11587
11588 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11589
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011590allow-0rtt
11591 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011592 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11593 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011594
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011595alpn <protocols>
11596 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11597 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11598 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011599 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011600 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11601 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11602 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11603 now obsolete NPN extension.
11604 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11605 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11606
11607 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011609backup
11610 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11611 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11612 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11613 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011614 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11615 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011616
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011617ca-file <cafile>
11618 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11619 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11620 server's certificate.
11621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011622check
11623 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011624 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11625 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11626 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11627 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11628 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11629 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11630 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011631 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11632 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011633 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11634 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011635
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011636check-send-proxy
11637 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11638 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11639 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11640 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11641 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11642 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11643 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11644
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011645check-alpn <protocols>
11646 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11647 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11648 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11649
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011650check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011651 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011652 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11653 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011654
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011655check-ssl
11656 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11657 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11658 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11659 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011660 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011661 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11662 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011663 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011664 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11665 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011666
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011667check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011668 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011669 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11670 for normal traffic.
11671
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011672ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11674 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11675 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011676 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11677 information and recommendations see e.g.
11678 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11679 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11680 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011681
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011682ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11684 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11685 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11686 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011687 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11688 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11689 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011691cookie <value>
11692 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11693 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11694 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11695 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11696 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11697 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11698 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11699
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011700crl-file <crlfile>
11701 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11702 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11703 to verify server's certificate.
11704
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011705crt <cert>
11706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11707 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11708 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11709 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11710 certificate request.
11711
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011712disabled
11713 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11714 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11715 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11716 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11717 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011718 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011719
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011720enabled
11721 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11722 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11723 default value.
11724 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11725 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011727error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011728 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11729 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11730 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011732 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011733
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011734fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011735 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11736 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11737 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11738
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011739force-sslv3
11740 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11741 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011742 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011743 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011744
11745force-tlsv10
11746 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011747 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011748 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011749
11750force-tlsv11
11751 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011752 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011753 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011754
11755force-tlsv12
11756 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011757 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011758 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011759
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011760force-tlsv13
11761 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11762 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011763 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011765id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011766 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11767 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11768 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011769
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011770init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11771 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11772 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011773 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011774 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11775 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11776 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11777 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11778 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11779 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11780 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11781 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11782 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011783 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011784 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11785 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11786 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11787 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11788 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11789 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011790 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011791
11792 Example:
11793 defaults
11794 # never fail on address resolution
11795 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011797inter <delay>
11798fastinter <delay>
11799downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011800 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11801 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11802 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11803 between checks depending on the server state :
11804
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011805 Server state | Interval used
11806 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11807 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11808 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11809 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11810 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11811 or yet unchecked. |
11812 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11813 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11814 | "inter" otherwise.
11815 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011817 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11818 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11819 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11820 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011821 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11822 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11823 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11824 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11825 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011827maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011828 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11829 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011830 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11831 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011832 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11833 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11834 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11835 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11836
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011837 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11838 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11839 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11840 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11841 than 50 concurrent requests.
11842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011843maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011844 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11845 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11846 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11847 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11848 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11849 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11850 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11851
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011852max-reuse <count>
11853 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11854 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11855 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11856 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11857 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11858 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11859 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11860 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011862minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011863 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11864 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11865 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11866 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11867 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11868 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011869 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011870 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011871
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011872namespace <name>
11873 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11874 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11875 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11876 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11877
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011878no-agent-check
11879 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11880 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11881 default value.
11882 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11883 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11884
11885no-backup
11886 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11887 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11888 default value.
11889 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11890 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11891
11892no-check
11893 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11894 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11895 default value.
11896 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11897 "default-server" "check" setting.
11898
11899no-check-ssl
11900 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11901 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11902 default value.
11903 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11904 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11905
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011906no-send-proxy
11907 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11908 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11909 default value.
11910 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11911 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11912
11913no-send-proxy-v2
11914 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11915 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11916 default value.
11917 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11918 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11919
11920no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11921 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11922 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11923 default value.
11924 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11925 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11926
11927no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11928 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11929 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11930 default value.
11931 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11932 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11933
11934no-ssl
11935 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11936 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11937 default value.
11938 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11939 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11940
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011941no-ssl-reuse
11942 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11943 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11944 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11945 and for paranoid users.
11946
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011947no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011948 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11949 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011950 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011951
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011952 Supported in default-server: No
11953
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011954no-tls-tickets
11955 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11956 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11957 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011958 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11959 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011960 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011961
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011962no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011963 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011964 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11965 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011966 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11967 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011968 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011969
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011970 Supported in default-server: No
11971
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011972no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011973 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011974 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11975 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011976 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11977 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011978 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011979
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011980 Supported in default-server: No
11981
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011982no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011983 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011984 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11985 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011986 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11987 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011988 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011989
11990 Supported in default-server: No
11991
11992no-tlsv13
11993 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11994 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11995 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11996 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11997 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011998 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011999
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012000 Supported in default-server: No
12001
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012002no-verifyhost
12003 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12004 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12005 default value.
12006 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12007 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012008
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012009no-tfo
12010 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12011 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12012 default value.
12013 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12014 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12015
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012016non-stick
12017 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12018 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12019 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12020
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012021npn <protocols>
12022 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12023 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12024 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012025 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012026 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12027 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12028 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012030observe <mode>
12031 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12032 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12033 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12034 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12035 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12036 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012037 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012038
12039 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012041on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012042 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12043 Currently, four modes are available:
12044 - fastinter: force fastinter
12045 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12046 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12047 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12048 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12049
12050 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12051
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012052on-marked-down <action>
12053 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12054 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012055 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12056 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12057 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12058 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12059 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12060 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12061 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12062 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012063
12064 Actions are disabled by default
12065
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012066on-marked-up <action>
12067 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12068 Currently one action is available:
12069 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12070 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12071 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12072 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012073 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12074 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012075 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12076 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12077
12078 Actions are disabled by default
12079
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012080pool-max-conn <max>
12081 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12082 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12083 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12084 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12085 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12086 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12087
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012088pool-purge-delay <delay>
12089 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012090 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012091 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012093port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012094 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12095 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12096 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12097 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12098 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12099 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12100
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012101proto <name>
12102
12103 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12104 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12105 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12106 reported in haproxy -vv.
12107 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12108 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012110redir <prefix>
12111 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12112 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12113 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12114 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12115 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12116 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12117 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12118 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012119 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012120 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012121 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12122 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12123 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12124 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12125
12126 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012128rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012129 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12130 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12131 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12132
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012133resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12134 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12135 server.
12136
12137 Available options:
12138
12139 * allow-dup-ip
12140 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12141 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12142 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12143 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12144 For such case, simply enable this option.
12145 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12146
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012147 * ignore-weight
12148 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12149 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12150 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12151
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012152 * prevent-dup-ip
12153 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12154 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12155 same fqdn.
12156 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12157
12158 Example:
12159 backend b_myapp
12160 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12161 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12162 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12163
12164 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12165 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12166 it
12167 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12168 different address
12169
12170 Default value: not set
12171
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012172resolve-prefer <family>
12173 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12174 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12175 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12176 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12177
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012178 Default value: ipv6
12179
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012180 Example:
12181
12182 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012183
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012184resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012185 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012186 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012187 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012188 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12189 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012190 configured network, another address is selected.
12191
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012192 Example:
12193
12194 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012195
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012196resolvers <id>
12197 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12198 hostname.
12199
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012200 Example:
12201
12202 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012203
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012204 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012205
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012206send-proxy
12207 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12208 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12209 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12210 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012211 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12212 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12213 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12214 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12215 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12216 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12217 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12218 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12219 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12220 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012221 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12222 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012223
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012224send-proxy-v2
12225 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12226 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12227 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12228 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012229 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12230 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12231 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12232 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012233
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012234proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12235 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12236 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012237 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12238 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012239 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12240 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012241 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012242
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012243send-proxy-v2-ssl
12244 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12245 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12246 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12247 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12248 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12249 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12250 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012251 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12252 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012253
12254send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12255 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12256 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12257 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12258 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12259 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12260 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12261 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12262 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012263 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12264 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012265
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012266slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012267 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12268 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12269 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12270 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12271 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12272 parameters :
12273
12274 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12275 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12276
12277 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12278 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12279 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12280 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12281
12282 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12283 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12284 seen as failed.
12285
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012286sni <expression>
12287 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12288 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12289 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12290 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012291 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12292 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012293 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012294 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12295 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012296
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012297source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012298source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012299source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012300 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12301 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12302 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12303 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12304
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012305 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12306 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12307 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12308 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12309 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12310 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12311 server.
12312
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012313 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12314 specifying the source address without port(s).
12315
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012316ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012317 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12318 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12319 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12320 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12321 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12322 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012323 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12324 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012325
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012326ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12327 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12328 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12329 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12330
12331ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12332 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12333 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12334 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12335
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012336ssl-reuse
12337 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12338 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12339 default value.
12340 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12341 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12342
12343stick
12344 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12345 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12346 default value.
12347 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12348 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012349
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012350socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012351 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012352 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12353 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12354
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012355tcp-ut <delay>
12356 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12357 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12358 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012359 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012360 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12361 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12362 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12363 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12364 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12365 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12366 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12367 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12368 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12369
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012370tfo
12371 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12372 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12373 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12374 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12375 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012376 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012378track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012379 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12380 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12381 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12382 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012383 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12384
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012385tls-tickets
12386 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12387 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12388 default value.
12389 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12390 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012391
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012392verify [none|required]
12393 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012394 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012395 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12396 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012397 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012398 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12399 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12400 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12401 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12402 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12403 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12404 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12405 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012406
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012407verifyhost <hostname>
12408 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012409 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12410 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12411 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12412 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12413 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12414 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12415 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12416 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012418weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012419 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12420 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12421 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012422 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12423 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12424 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12425 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12426 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12427 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012428
12429
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124305.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12431-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012432
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012433HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12434using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12435configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012436This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12437can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12438workload.
12439This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12440resolution at run time.
12441Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12442carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12443
12444
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124455.3.1. Global overview
12446----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012447
12448As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12449different steps of the process life:
12450
12451 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12452 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12453 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12454
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012455 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12456 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012457
12458A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12459 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12460 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12461 resolution to know this new IP.
12462
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012463When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012464HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012465SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12466from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12467will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12468will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012469
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012470A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012471 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012472 first valid response.
12473
12474 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12475 servers return an error.
12476
12477
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124785.3.2. The resolvers section
12479----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012480
12481This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012482HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12483contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012484
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012485When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12486uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12487is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12488answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12489
12490When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012491used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012492
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012493 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12494 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12495 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012496
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012497 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12498 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012499
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012500 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12501 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12502 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012503
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012504For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12505following scenarios are possible:
12506
12507 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12508 ignored
12509
12510 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12511 applied
12512
12513 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12514 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12515
12516 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12517 retries the query with a new type
12518
12519 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12520 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012521
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012522As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12523a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012524<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012525
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012526
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012527resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012528 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012529
12530A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12531
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012532accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012533 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012534 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012535 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12536 by RFC 6891)
12537
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012538 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12539
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012540nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12541 DNS server description:
12542 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12543 <ip> : IP address of the server
12544 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12545
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012546parse-resolv-conf
12547 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12548 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12549 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12550
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012551hold <status> <period>
12552 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12553 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012554 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012555 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012556 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12557 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12558 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12559
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012560 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012561
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012562resolve_retries <nb>
12563 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12564 giving up.
12565 Default value: 3
12566
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012567 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12568 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12569 type.
12570
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012571timeout <event> <time>
12572 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12573 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12574 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012575 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12576 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012577 Default value: 1s
12578 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012579 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012580 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012581 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12582 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12583
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012584 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012585
12586 resolvers mydns
12587 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12588 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012589 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012590 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012591 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012592 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012593 hold other 30s
12594 hold refused 30s
12595 hold nx 30s
12596 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012597 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012598 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012599
12600
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200126016. Cache
12602---------
12603
12604HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12605(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12606RAM.
12607
12608The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12609this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12610
12611If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12612independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12613when we try to allocate a new one.
12614
12615The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12616
12617It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12618"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12619for more details.
12620
12621When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12622replaced by "<CACHE>".
12623
12624
126256.1. Limitation
12626----------------
12627
12628The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12629
12630- If the response is not a 200
12631- If the response contains a Vary header
12632- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12633- If the response is not cacheable
12634
12635- If the request is not a GET
12636- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12637- If the request contains an Authorization header
12638
12639
126406.2. Setup
12641-----------
12642
12643To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12644the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12645
12646
126476.2.1. Cache section
12648---------------------
12649
12650cache <name>
12651 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12652 size of cache is mandatory.
12653
12654total-max-size <megabytes>
12655 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12656 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12657
12658max-object-size <bytes>
12659 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12660 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12661 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12662
12663max-age <seconds>
12664 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12665 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12666 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12667 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12668 default.
12669
12670
126716.2.2. Proxy section
12672---------------------
12673
12674http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12675 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12676 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12677 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12678 after this one.
12679
12680http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12681 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12682 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12683 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12684 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12685
12686
12687Example:
12688
12689 backend bck1
12690 mode http
12691
12692 http-request cache-use foobar
12693 http-response cache-store foobar
12694 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12695
12696 cache foobar
12697 total-max-size 4
12698 max-age 240
12699
12700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127017. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12702----------------------------------
12703
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012704HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012705client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12706The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12707these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12708but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12709data called patterns.
12710
12711
127127.1. ACL basics
12713---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012714
12715The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12716content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12717from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12718simple :
12719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012720 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012721 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12723 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012725The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12726adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012727
12728In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012730 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012731
12732This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12733Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12734and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012735an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12736conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12737as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12738are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012739
12740ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12741'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12742which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12743
12744There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12745performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012747The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12748specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12749this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012750methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12751ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012752
12753Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12754 - boolean
12755 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12756 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12757 - string
12758 - data block
12759
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012760Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12761converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12762would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12763The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12764which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12765
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012766Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12767keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12768fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12769which are summarized in the table below :
12770
12771 +---------------------+-----------------+
12772 | Sample or converter | Default |
12773 | output type | matching method |
12774 +---------------------+-----------------+
12775 | boolean | bool |
12776 +---------------------+-----------------+
12777 | integer | int |
12778 +---------------------+-----------------+
12779 | ip | ip |
12780 +---------------------+-----------------+
12781 | string | str |
12782 +---------------------+-----------------+
12783 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12784 +---------------------+-----------------+
12785
12786Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12787matching method, see below.
12788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012789The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12790 - boolean
12791 - integer or integer range
12792 - IP address / network
12793 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12794 - regular expression
12795 - hex block
12796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012797The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12798
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012799 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12800 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012802 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012803 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012804 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012805 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012807The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12808read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12809if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12810lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12811will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12812beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12813a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12814lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12815exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12816
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012817The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12818parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12819ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12820a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12821check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12822
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012823The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12824socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12825file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012827Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12828loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12829
12830 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12831
12832In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12833the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12834case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12835as well.
12836
12837The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12838sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12839do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12840methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12841is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012842obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012843followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12844default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12845that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12846string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12847
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012848The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12849By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12850string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12851resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12852server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012853waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012854flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12855function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012857There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12858sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12859be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012860
12861 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12862 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012863 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12864 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12865 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12866 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012867
12868 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12869 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012870 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012871
12872 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012873 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012874
12875 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012876 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012877
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012878 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012879 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12880
12881 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12882 binary or string samples.
12883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012884 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12885 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012887 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12888 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12889 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012891 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12892 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012894 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12895 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012897 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12898 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012900 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12901 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012902 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012904 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12905 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12906 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012907
12908For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12909request, it is possible to do :
12910
12911 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12912
12913In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12914buffer, one would use the following acl :
12915
12916 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12917
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012918On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12919possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12920
12921 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012923All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12924criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12925method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12926to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12927criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12928the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012930If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012931the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12932For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012934 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12935 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12936 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12937 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012938
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012939
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012940The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12941types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12942combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12943brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12944default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946 +-------------------------------------------------+
12947 | Input sample type |
12948 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012949 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012950 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12951 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12952 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012953 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012954 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012955 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012956 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012957 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012958 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012959 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012960 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012961 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012962 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012963 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012964 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012965 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012966 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012967 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012968 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012969 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012970 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012971 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012973 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012974 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12975 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12976 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012977
12978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129797.1.1. Matching booleans
12980------------------------
12981
12982In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12983Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12984When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12985that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12986
12987Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12988return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12989"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12990
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129927.1.2. Matching integers
12993------------------------
12994
12995Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12996enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12997to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12998
12999Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13000matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13001lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013002
13003For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13004unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13005representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13006
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013007As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13008two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13009instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13010ranges and operators.
13011
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013012For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013013operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13014Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13015of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013017Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013018
13019 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13020 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13021 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13022 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13023 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013025For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013026
13027 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13028
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013029This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13030
13031 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13032
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130347.1.3. Matching strings
13035-----------------------
13036
13037String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13038different forms :
13039
13040 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013041 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013042
13043 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013044 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013045
13046 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13047 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13048
13049 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13050 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13051
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013052 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013053 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13054 matches.
13055
13056 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13057 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13058 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013059
13060String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13061exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13062characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13063string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13064to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013065before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013066
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013067Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13068(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13069Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13070
13071Example:
13072 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13073 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13074
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130767.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13077---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013078
13079Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13080they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13081possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13082passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13083the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013084the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13085match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013086
13087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130887.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13089-------------------------------------
13090
13091It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13092not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13093a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13094to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13095digits may be used upper or lower case.
13096
13097Example :
13098 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13099 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13100
13101
131027.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13103---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013104
13105IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13106netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13107within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013108host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013109difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13110at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13111does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13112parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013113
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013114The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13115abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13116
13117 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13118 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13119 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13120 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13121 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13122 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13123 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13124 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13125
13126Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13127192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13128
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013129IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13130Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13131trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13132IPv6 patterns.
13133
13134HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13135following situations :
13136 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13137 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13138 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13139 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13140 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13141 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13142 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13143 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13144 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13145 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013147
131487.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13149----------------------------------
13150
13151Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13152combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13153
13154 - AND (implicit)
13155 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13156 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013158A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013160 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013162Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13163indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013165For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13166"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13167requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13168is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13169
13170 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013171 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13172 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13173 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013174
13175To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13176and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13177
13178 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13179 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13180 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13181 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13182
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013183 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013184 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13185 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13186 use_backend www if host_www
13187
13188It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13189expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13190be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13191the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13192
13193 The following rule :
13194
13195 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013196 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013197
13198 Can also be written that way :
13199
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013200 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013201
13202It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13203to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13204simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13205sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13206good use is the following :
13207
13208 With named ACLs :
13209
13210 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13211 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13212 monitor fail if site_dead
13213
13214 With anonymous ACLs :
13215
13216 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13217
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013218See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13219keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013220
13221
132227.3. Fetching samples
13223---------------------
13224
13225Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13226against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13227sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13228ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13229of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13230available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13231
13232This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13233Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13234compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13235deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13236
13237The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13238matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13239method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13240indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13241
13242As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13243when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13244mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13245the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13246ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13247
13248Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13249multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13250when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013251incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13252are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013253is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13254all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13255
13256Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13257 - name
13258 - name(arg1)
13259 - name(arg1,arg2)
13260
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013261
132627.3.1. Converters
13263-----------------
13264
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013265Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13266of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13267is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13268was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013269has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013270unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13271
13272These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13273sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13274the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013275support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013276
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013277A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13278support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13279supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13280(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13281bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013283The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013284
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001328551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13286 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13287 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13288 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13289 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13290 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13291
13292 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013293 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13294 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013295 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13296 frontend http-in
13297 bind *:8081
13298 default_backend servers
13299 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13300 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13301
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013302add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013303 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013304 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013305 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13306 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013307 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013308 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13309 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13310 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13311 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013312 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013313 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013314
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013315aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13316 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13317 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13318 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13319 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13320 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13321 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13322
13323 Example:
13324 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13325 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13326
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013327and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013328 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013329 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013330 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13331 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013332 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013333 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13334 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13335 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13336 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013337 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013338 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013339
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013340b64dec
13341 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13342 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13343
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013344base64
13345 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013346 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013347 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13348
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013349bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013350 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013351 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013352 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013353 presence of a flag).
13354
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013355bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13356 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13357 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013358 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013359
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013360concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13361 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13362 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13363 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13364 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13365 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13366 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13367 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13368 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13369 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13370 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013371 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013372 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013373 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013374
13375 Example:
13376 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13377 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13378 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13379 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13380
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013381cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013382 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13383 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013384
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013385crc32([<avalanche>])
13386 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13387 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13388 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13389 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13390 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13391 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13392 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13393 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13394 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13395 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013396 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13397
13398crc32c([<avalanche>])
13399 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13400 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13401 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13402 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13403 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13404 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13405 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13406 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013407
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013408da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013409 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13410 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13411 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13412 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013413 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013414 configuration language.
13415
13416 Example:
13417 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013418 bind *:8881
13419 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013420 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013421
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013422debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13423 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13424 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13425 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13426 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13427 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13428 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13429 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13430 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13431 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13432 printable sample types.
13433
13434 Example:
13435 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013436
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013437div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013438 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13439 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013440 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013441 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13442 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013443 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013444 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13445 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13446 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13447 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013448 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013449 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013450
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013451djb2([<avalanche>])
13452 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13453 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13454 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13455 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13456 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13457 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13458 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013459 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13460 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013461
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013462even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013463 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013464 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13465
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013466field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13467 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13468 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13469 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13470 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13471 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13472 fields.
13473
13474 Example :
13475 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13476 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13477 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13478 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13479 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013480
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013481hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013482 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013483 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013484 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013485 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013486
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013487hex2i
13488 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013489 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013490
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013491http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013492 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13493 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013494 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13495 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13496 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13497 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13498 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13499 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13500 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13501 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013502
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013503in_table(<table>)
13504 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13505 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13506 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013507 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013508 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13509
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013510ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13511 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013512 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013513 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13514 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13515 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13516 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13517 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013518
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013519json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013520 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013521 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013522 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013523 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13524 of errors:
13525 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13526 bytes, ...)
13527 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13528 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13529
13530 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13531 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13532 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13533 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13534 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13535 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013536 - "ascii" : never fails;
13537 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13538 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013539 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013540 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013541 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13542 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13543
13544 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013545 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013546
13547 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013548 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013549 capture request header user-agent len 150
13550 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013551
13552 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13553 GET / HTTP/1.0
13554 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13555
13556 Output log:
13557 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13558
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013559language(<value>[,<default>])
13560 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13561 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13562 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13563 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13564 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13565 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13566 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13567 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13568 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013569 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013570 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13571 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013572
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013573 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013575 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13576 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013577
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013578 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13579 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13580 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13581 use_backend spanish if es
13582 use_backend french if fr
13583 use_backend english if en
13584 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013585
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013586length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013587 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13588 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13589 type. The result is of type integer.
13590
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013591lower
13592 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13593 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13594 type. The result is of type string.
13595
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013596ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13597 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13598 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13599 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13600 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13601 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13602 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13603
13604 Example :
13605
13606 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013607 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013608 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13609
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013610map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13611map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13612map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13613 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13614 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13615 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13616 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13617 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13618 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13619 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13620 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013621
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013622 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13623 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13624 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013625
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013626 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013627 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013628
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013629 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13630 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13631 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13632 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013633 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13634 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013635 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13636 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13637 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13638 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13639 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13640 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13641 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13642 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013643 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13644 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13645 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013646 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13647 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13648 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13649 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13650 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013651
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013652 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13653 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13654 the corresponding match text.
13655
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013656 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13657 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13658 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13659 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13660 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013662 Example :
13663
13664 # this is a comment and is ignored
13665 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13666 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13667 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13668 | | | `---------- value
13669 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13670 | `---------------------------- key
13671 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13672
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013673mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013674 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13675 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013676 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013677 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013678 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013679 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13680 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13681 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13682 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013683 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013684 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013685
13686mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013687 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013688 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13689 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013690 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013691 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013692 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013693 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13694 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13695 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13696 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013697 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013698 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013699
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013700nbsrv
13701 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13702 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13703 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13704 map lookup.
13705
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013706neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013707 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13708 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13709 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13710 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013711
13712not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013713 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013714 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013715 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013716 absence of a flag).
13717
13718odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013719 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013720 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13721
13722or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013723 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013724 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013725 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13726 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013727 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013728 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13729 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13730 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13731 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013732 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013733 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013734
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013735protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13736 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13737 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13738 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13739 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13740 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13741 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13742 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13743 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13744 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13745 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13746 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13747
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013748regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013749 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13750 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13751 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13752 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13753 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13754 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13755 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13756 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13757 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13758 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013759 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13760 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13761 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13762 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013763
13764 Example :
13765
13766 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13767 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13768 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13769 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13770
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013771capture-req(<id>)
13772 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13773 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13774
13775 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013776 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13777 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013778
13779capture-res(<id>)
13780 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13781 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13782
13783 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013784 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13785 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013786
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013787sdbm([<avalanche>])
13788 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13789 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13790 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13791 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13792 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13793 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13794 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013795 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13796 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013797
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013798set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013799 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13800 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13801 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013802 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013803 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13804 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013805 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013806 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13807 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013808 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013809 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013810
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013811sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013812 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013813 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13814
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013815sha2([<bits>])
13816 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13817 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13818
13819 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13820 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13821
13822 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13823 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13824
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013825srv_queue
13826 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13827 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13828 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13829 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13830 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13831
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013832strcmp(<var>)
13833 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13834 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13835 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13836 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13837 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13838 shorter).
13839
13840 Example :
13841
13842 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13843 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13844 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13845
13846
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013847sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013848 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13849 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013850 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013851 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13852 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013853 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013854 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13855 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013856 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013857 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13858 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013859 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013860 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013861
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013862table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13863 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13864 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13865 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13866 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13867 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13868 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13869
13870
13871table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13872 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13873 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13874 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13875 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13876 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13877 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13878
13879table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013883 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13884 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13885
13886table_conn_cur(<table>)
13887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13889 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13890 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13891 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13892
13893table_conn_rate(<table>)
13894 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13895 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13896 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13897 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13898 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13899
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013900table_gpt0(<table>)
13901 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13902 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13903 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13904 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13905 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13906
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013907table_gpc0(<table>)
13908 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13909 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13910 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13911 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13912 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13913
13914table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13915 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13916 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13917 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13918 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13919 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13920 sample fetch keyword.
13921
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013922table_gpc1(<table>)
13923 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13924 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13925 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13926 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13927 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13928
13929table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13930 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13931 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13932 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13933 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13934 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13935 sample fetch keyword.
13936
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013937table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13938 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13939 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013940 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013941 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13942 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13943
13944table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13945 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13946 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13947 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13948 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13949 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13950 keyword.
13951
13952table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13953 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13954 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013955 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013956 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13957 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13958
13959table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13962 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13963 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13964 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13965 keyword.
13966
13967table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13968 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13969 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013970 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013971 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13972 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13973 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13974 keyword.
13975
13976table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013979 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013980 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13981 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13982 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13983 keyword.
13984
13985table_server_id(<table>)
13986 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13987 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13988 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13989 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13990 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13991 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13992
13993table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13994 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13995 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013996 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013997 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13998 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13999 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14000 keyword.
14001
14002table_sess_rate(<table>)
14003 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14004 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14005 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14006 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14007 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14008 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14009 keyword.
14010
14011table_trackers(<table>)
14012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14014 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14015 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14016 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14017 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14018 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14019 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14020 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14021 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14022
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014023upper
14024 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14025 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14026 type. The result is of type string.
14027
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014028url_dec
14029 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14030 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14031
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014032ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014033 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014034 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14035 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14036 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014037 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14038 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14039 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14040 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014041 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014042 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14043 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014044
14045 Example:
14046 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14047 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14048
14049 message Point {
14050 int32 latitude = 1;
14051 int32 longitude = 2;
14052 }
14053
14054 message PPoint {
14055 Point point = 59;
14056 }
14057
14058 message Rectangle {
14059 // One corner of the rectangle.
14060 PPoint lo = 48;
14061 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14062 PPoint hi = 49;
14063 }
14064
14065 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14066 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14067 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14068
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014069 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14070 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014071 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014072 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14073
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014074 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014075
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014076 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014077
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014078 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014079 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14080 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14081
14082 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14083 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14084 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14085
14086 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14087 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14088 interpret the previous binary sample.
14089
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014090
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014091unset-var(<var name>)
14092 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14093 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14094 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14095 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14096 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14097 response),
14098 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14099 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14100 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14101 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14102
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014103utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14104 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14105 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14106 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14107 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14108 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14109 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14110
14111 Example :
14112
14113 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014114 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014115 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14116
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014117word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14118 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14119 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14120 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14121 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14122 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14123
14124 Example :
14125 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14126 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14127 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14128 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14129 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014130
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014131wt6([<avalanche>])
14132 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14133 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14134 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14135 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14136 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14137 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14138 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014139 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14140 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014141
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014142xor(<value>)
14143 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014144 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014145 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014146 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014147 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014148 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14149 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014150 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014151 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14152 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014153 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014154 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014155
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014156xxh32([<seed>])
14157 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14158 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14159 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14160 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14161 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14162 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14163 as cryptographically secure.
14164
14165xxh64([<seed>])
14166 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14167 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14168 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14169 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14170 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14171 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14172 as cryptographically secure.
14173
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014174
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014176--------------------------------------------
14177
14178A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14179not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14180"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14181The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14182
14183always_false : boolean
14184 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14185 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14186
14187always_true : boolean
14188 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14189 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14190
14191avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014192 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014193 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14194 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14195 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14196 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14197 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14198 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14199 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14200 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14201 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14202 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14203 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14204 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14205 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014207be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014208 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14209 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14210 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14211 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014212 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14213
14214be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14215 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14216 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14217 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14218 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14219 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014220 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14221 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014222
14223 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14224 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14225 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014227be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14228 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14229 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14230 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014231 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014232 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14233 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014234
14235 Example :
14236 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14237 backend dynamic
14238 mode http
14239 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14240 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014241
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014242bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014243 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14244 of the string.
14245
14246bool(<bool>) : bool
14247 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14248 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014250connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14251 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014252 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14254 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014255
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014256 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014257 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014258 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14259
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014260 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14261 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014262
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014263 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014264 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014265 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014266 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014267 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014268 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014269 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014270
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014271 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14272 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014273 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014274 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014275
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014276cpu_calls : integer
14277 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14278 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14279 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14280 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14281 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14282 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14283
14284cpu_ns_avg : integer
14285 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14286 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14287 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14288 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14289 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14290 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14291 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14292 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14293 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14294 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14295 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14296
14297cpu_ns_tot : integer
14298 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14299 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14300 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14301 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14302 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14303 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14304 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14305 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14306 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14307 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14308 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14309 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14310 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14311
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014312date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014313 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014314
14315 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14316 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14317 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014318 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14319
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014320 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14321 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14322 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14323 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14324 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14325
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014326 Example :
14327
14328 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14329 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014330
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014331 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14332 # millisecond granularity
14333 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14334
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014335date_us : integer
14336 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14337 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14338 from the same timeval structure.
14339
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014340distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14341 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14342 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14343 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14344 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14345 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14346 list of supported tokens.
14347
14348distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14349 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14350 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14351 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14352 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14353 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14354 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14355 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14356 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14357 supported tokens.
14358
14359 Example :
14360 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14361 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14362 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14363 # send large files to the big farm
14364 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14365
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014366env(<name>) : string
14367 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14368 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14369 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14370 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14371 certain way.
14372
14373 Examples :
14374 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14375 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14376
14377 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14378 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14381 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014382 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14383 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014384 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14385 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014386 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014387 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14388 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014389
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014390fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14391 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14392 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14393 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014395fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14397 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14398 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14399 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14400 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14401 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14402 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14403 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014404
14405 Example :
14406 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14407 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14408 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14409 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14410 frontend mail
14411 bind :25
14412 mode tcp
14413 maxconn 100
14414 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14415 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14416 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14417 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014418
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014419hostname : string
14420 Returns the system hostname.
14421
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014422int(<integer>) : signed integer
14423 Returns a signed integer.
14424
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014425ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14426 Returns an ipv4.
14427
14428ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14429 Returns an ipv6.
14430
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014431lat_ns_avg : integer
14432 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14433 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14434 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14435 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14436 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14437 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14438 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14439 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14440 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14441 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14442 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14443 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14444 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14445 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14446
14447lat_ns_tot : integer
14448 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14449 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14450 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14451 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14452 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14453 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14454 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14455 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14456 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14457 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14458 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14459 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14460 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14461 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14462 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14463 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14464 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14465 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14466 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14467
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014468meth(<method>) : method
14469 Returns a method.
14470
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014471nbproc : integer
14472 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14473 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14474 and debugging purposes.
14475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14477 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14478 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14479 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014480 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14481 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14482 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014483
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014484prio_class : integer
14485 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14486 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14487 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14488
14489prio_offset : integer
14490 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14491 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14492 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14493 set-priority-offset".
14494
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014495proc : integer
14496 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14497 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14498 debugging purposes.
14499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014500queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014501 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14502 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14503 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014504 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14505 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14506 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14507 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14508 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14509
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014510rand([<range>]) : integer
14511 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14512 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14513 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14514 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14515 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14516
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014517uuid([<version>]) : string
14518 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14519 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14520 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014522srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14523 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14524 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14525 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14526 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14527 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014528 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14529 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14530
14531srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14532 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14533 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14534 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14535 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14536 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14537 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14538 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14539
14540 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14541 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014542
14543srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14544 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14545 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14546 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014547 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014548 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14549 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14550 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14551
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014552srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14553 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14554 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14555 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14556 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14557 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14558 fetch methods.
14559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014560srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14561 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14562 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014563 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014564 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14565 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014566 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567 overloading servers).
14568
14569 Example :
14570 # Redirect to a separate back
14571 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14572 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14573 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14574
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014575stopping : boolean
14576 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14577 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14578 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14579
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014580str(<string>) : string
14581 Returns a string.
14582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014583table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14584 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14585 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14586
14587table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14588 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14589 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14590 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14591
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014592thread : integer
14593 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14594 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14595 and debugging purposes.
14596
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014597var(<var-name>) : undefined
14598 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014599 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14600 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014601 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014602 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14603 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014604 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014605 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14606 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014607 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014608 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014609
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146107.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014611----------------------------------
14612
14613The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14614closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14615methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14616sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14617TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014618the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14619counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014620"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14621used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14622can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14623Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14624table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14625tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14626currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014627
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014628bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014629 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14630 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14631 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014633be_id : integer
14634 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14635 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14636
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014637be_name : string
14638 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14639 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014641dst : ip
14642 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14643 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14644 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14645 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014646 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14647 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14648 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14649 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14650 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14651 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014652
14653dst_conn : integer
14654 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14655 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14656 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14657 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14658 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14659 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14660 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14661 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014662
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014663dst_is_local : boolean
14664 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14665 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14666 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14667 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014668 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014669 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14670 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14671 it only once per connection.
14672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014673dst_port : integer
14674 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14675 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14676 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14677 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14678 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14679 an HTTP header.
14680
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014681fc_http_major : integer
14682 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14683 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14684 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14685
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014686fc_pp_authority : string
14687 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14688 if any.
14689
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014690fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14691 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14692 header.
14693
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014694fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14695 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14696 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14697 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14698 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14699 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14700 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14701
14702fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14703 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14704 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14705 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14706 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14707 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14708 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14709
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014710fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014711 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14712 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14713 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14714 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14715
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014716fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014717 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14718 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14719 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14720 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14721
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014722fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014723 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14724 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14725 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14726 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14727
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014728fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014729 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14730 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14731 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14732 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14733
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014734fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014735 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14736 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14737 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14738 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14739
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014740fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014741 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14742 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14743 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14744 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14745
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014746fe_defbe : string
14747 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14748 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014750fe_id : integer
14751 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014752 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014753 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14754
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014755fe_name : string
14756 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14757 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14758 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14759
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014760sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014761sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14762sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14763sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014764 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14765 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14766 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14767
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014768sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014769sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14770sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14771sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014772 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14773 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14774 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14775
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014776sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014777sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14778sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14779sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014780 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14781 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014782 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14783 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14784 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014785
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014786 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014787 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14788 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014789 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14790 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14791 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014792 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14793 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14794
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014795sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14796sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14797sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14798sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14799 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14800 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14801 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14802 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14803 when a first ACL was verified.
14804
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014805sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014806sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14807sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14808sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014809 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014810 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14811
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014812sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014813sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14814sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14815sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014816 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14817 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14818 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14819
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014820sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014821sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14822sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14823sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014824 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14825 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14826 See also src_conn_rate.
14827
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014828sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014829sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14830sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14831sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014832 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014833 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014834
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014835sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14836sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14837sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14838sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14839 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14840 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14841
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014842sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14843sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14844sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14845sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14846 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14847 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14848
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014849sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014850sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14851sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14852sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014853 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14854 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14855 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014856 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14857 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14858 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014859
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014860sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14861sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14862sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14863sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14864 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14865 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14866 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14867 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14868 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14869 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14870
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014871sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014872sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14873sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14874sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014875 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014876 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14877 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14878
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014879sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014880sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14881sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14882sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014883 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14884 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14885 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14886 src_http_err_rate.
14887
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014888sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014889sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14890sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14891sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014892 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014893 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14894 src_http_req_cnt.
14895
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014896sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014897sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14898sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14899sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014900 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14901 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14902 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14903 src_http_req_rate.
14904
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014905sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014906sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14907sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14908sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014909 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014910 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14911 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14912 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14913 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014914
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014915 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014916 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14917 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014918 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14919
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014920sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14921sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14922sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14923sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14924 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14925 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14926 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14927 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14928 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014930sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014931sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14932sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14933sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014934 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14935 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14936 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014937
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014938sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014939sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14940sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14941sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014942 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14943 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14944 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014945
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014946sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014947sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14948sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14949sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014950 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014951 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14952 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14953 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014954 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014955 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14956
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014957sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014958sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14959sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14960sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014961 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14962 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14963 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14964 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14965 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014966 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014967
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014968sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014969sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14970sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14971sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014972 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14973 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14974 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14975
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014976sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014977sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14978sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14979sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014980 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14981 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014982 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014983 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14984 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14986 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14987 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014989so_id : integer
14990 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14991 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14992 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014994src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014995 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014996 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14997 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14998 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014999 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15000 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15001 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015002 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15003 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15004 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15005 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15006 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15007 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15008 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015009
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015010 Example:
15011 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15012 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015014src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15015 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15016 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15017 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015018 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015020src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15021 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15022 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015023 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015024 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15027 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15028 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15029 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15030 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15031 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15032 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015033
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015034 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015035 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15036 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15037 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15038 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015039 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015040 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15041 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15042
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015043src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15044 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15045 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15046 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15047 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15048 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15049 was verified.
15050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015051src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015052 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015053 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015054 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015055 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015058 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015059 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15060 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015061 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015063src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15064 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15065 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15066 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015067 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015070 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015071 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015072 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015073 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015074
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015075src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15076 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15077 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15078 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15079 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15080
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015081src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15082 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15083 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15084 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15085 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015088 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015089 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015090 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15091 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015092 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15093 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15094 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015095
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015096src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15097 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15098 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15099 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15100 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15101 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15102 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15103 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015105src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015106 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015107 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015108 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015109 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015110 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15113 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15114 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15115 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15116 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015117 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015119src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015120 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015121 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15122 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015123 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015125src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15126 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15127 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15128 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015129 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015130 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15133 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15134 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15135 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015136 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015137 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15138 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015139
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015140 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015141 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015142 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015143 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015144
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015145src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15146 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15147 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15148 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15149 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15150 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15151 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15152
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015153src_is_local : boolean
15154 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15155 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15156 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15157 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015158 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015159 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15160 once per connection.
15161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015163 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15164 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15165 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15166 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15167 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015169src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015170 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15171 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15172 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15173 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15174 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176src_port : integer
15177 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15178 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15179 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15180 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015183 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015184 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15185 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15186 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015187 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15190 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15191 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15192 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15193 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015194 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15197 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15198 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15199 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15200 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15201 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15202 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15203 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15204 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015205
15206 Example :
15207 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15208 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15209 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15210 listen ssh
15211 bind :22
15212 mode tcp
15213 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015214 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015216 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015218srv_id : integer
15219 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15220 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15221 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015222
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015223srv_name : string
15224 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15225 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15226 debugging.
15227
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152287.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015229----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15232closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15233when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15234usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015235future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015236
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001523751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15238 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15239 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15240 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15241 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15242 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15243
15244 Example :
15245 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15246 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15247 # the request.
15248 frontend http-in
15249 bind *:8081
15250 default_backend servers
15251 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15252 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15253
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015254ssl_bc : boolean
15255 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15256 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15257 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15258
15259ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15260 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15261 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15262
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015263ssl_bc_alpn : string
15264 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15265 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015266 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015267 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15268 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15269 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15270 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15271 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15272 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15273
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015274ssl_bc_cipher : string
15275 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15276 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15277
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015278ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15279 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15280 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15281 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15282
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015283ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15284 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15285 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15286 session or a TLS ticket.
15287
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015288ssl_bc_npn : string
15289 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15290 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015291 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015292 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15293 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15294 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15295 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15296 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15297
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015298ssl_bc_protocol : string
15299 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15300 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15301
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015302ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015303 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015304 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15305 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015306
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015307ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15308 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15309 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15310 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15311
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015312ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15313 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15314 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15315 if session was reused or not.
15316
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015317ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15318 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15319 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15320 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15321 BoringSSL.
15322
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015323ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15324 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15325 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15328 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15329 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15330 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15331 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15332 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15335 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15336 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15337 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15338 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015339
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015340ssl_c_der : binary
15341 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15342 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15343 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015345ssl_c_err : integer
15346 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15347 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15348 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15349 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15350 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015351
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015352ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015353 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15354 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15355 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15356 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15357 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15358 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15359 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15360 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015361 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15362 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15363 LDAP v3.
15364 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15365 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015367ssl_c_key_alg : string
15368 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15369 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15370 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015372ssl_c_notafter : string
15373 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15374 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15375 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015377ssl_c_notbefore : string
15378 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15379 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15380 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015381
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015382ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15384 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15385 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15386 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15387 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15388 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15389 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15390 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015391 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15392 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15393 LDAP v3.
15394 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15395 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015397ssl_c_serial : binary
15398 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15399 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15400 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015402ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15403 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15404 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15405 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015406 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15407 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15408
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015409 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015410 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15413 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15414 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15415 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015417ssl_c_used : boolean
15418 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15419 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015421ssl_c_verify : integer
15422 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15423 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15424 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15425 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015427ssl_c_version : integer
15428 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15429 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015430
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015431ssl_f_der : binary
15432 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15433 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15434 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15435
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015436ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15438 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15439 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15440 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015441 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15443 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15444 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015445 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15446 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15447 LDAP v3.
15448 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15449 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015451ssl_f_key_alg : string
15452 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15453 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15454 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015456ssl_f_notafter : string
15457 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15458 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15459 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461ssl_f_notbefore : string
15462 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15463 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15464 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015465
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015466ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15468 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15469 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15470 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15471 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15472 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15473 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15474 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015475 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15476 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15477 LDAP v3.
15478 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15479 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481ssl_f_serial : binary
15482 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15483 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15484 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015485
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015486ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15487 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15488 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15489 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15492 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15493 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15494 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015496ssl_f_version : integer
15497 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15498 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15499
15500ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015501 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15502 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15503 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015505 Example :
15506 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15507 listen http-https
15508 bind :80
15509 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15510 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15511
15512ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15513 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15514 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15515
15516ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015517 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15519 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15520 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15521 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15522 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15523 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15524 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15525 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527ssl_fc_cipher : string
15528 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15529 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015530
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015531ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15532 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15533 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015534 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015535
15536ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15537 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15538 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015539 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015540
15541ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15542 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15543 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15544 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015545 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015546 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015547
15548ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15549 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15550 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015551 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015552
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015553ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15554 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15555 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15556 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015559 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15560 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015561 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15562 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15563 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15564 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015565
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015566ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15567 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15568 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15569 wait until the handshake happened.
15570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15572 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015573 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15574 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015575 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015576 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015577
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015578ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015579 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015580 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15581 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015584 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15586 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15587 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15588 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15589 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15590 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15591 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593ssl_fc_protocol : string
15594 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15595 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015596
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015597ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015598 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015599 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15600 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015601
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015602ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15603 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15604 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15605 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15608 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15609 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15610 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15611 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015612
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015613ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15614 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15615 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15616 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15617 BoringSSL.
15618
15619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620ssl_fc_sni : string
15621 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15622 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15623 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15624 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15625 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15626
15627 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15628 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15629 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015630 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015631 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15635 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15638 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15639 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015640
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015641
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156427.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15646sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15647only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15648For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15649be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15650can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15651sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15652for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15653content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015656 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15658 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15661 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015662 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015664
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015665req.hdrs : string
15666 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15667 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15668 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15669 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15670
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015671req.hdrs_bin : binary
15672 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15673 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15674 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15675 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15676 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15677 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15678
15679 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15680
15681 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15682 str: <int:length><bytes>
15683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015684req.len : integer
15685req_len : integer (deprecated)
15686 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15687 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15688 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15689 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15690 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15691 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15692 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15693 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15696 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015697 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15698 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15699 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15700 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702 ACL alternatives :
15703 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15706 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15707 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15708 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15709 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711 ACL alternatives :
15712 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716req.proto_http : boolean
15717req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15718 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15719 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15720 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15721 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15722 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15723 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15724 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 Example:
15727 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15728 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15729 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015730 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15733rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15734 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15735 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15736 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15737 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15738 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15739 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15740 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15743 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15744 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15745 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15746 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15747 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015749 ACL derivatives :
15750 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015752 Example :
15753 listen tse-farm
15754 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15755 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15756 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15757 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15758 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15759 persist rdp-cookie
15760 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15761 # This is only useful makes sense if
15762 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15763 stick-table type string size 204800
15764 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15765 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15766 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15769 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15772rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15773 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15774 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15775 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15776 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015778 ACL derivatives :
15779 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015780
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015781req.ssl_alpn : string
15782 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15783 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15784 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15785 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15786 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15787 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015788 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015789
15790 Examples :
15791 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15792 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15793 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015794 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015795 default_backend bk_default
15796
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015797req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15798 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15799 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015800 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15801 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15802 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15803 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15804 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015806req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15807req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15808 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15809 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15810 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15811 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15812 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15813 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15814 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015816req.ssl_sni : string
15817req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15818 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15819 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15820 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15821 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15822 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15823 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15824 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15825 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15826 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15827 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15828 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15829 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831 ACL derivatives :
15832 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834 Examples :
15835 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15836 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15837 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15838 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15839 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015840
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015841req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15842 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15843 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15844 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15845 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15846 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15847 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15848 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15849 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15850 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852req.ssl_ver : integer
15853req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15854 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15855 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15856 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15857 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15858 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15859 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15860 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015861 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015864 ACL derivatives :
15865 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015866
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015867res.len : integer
15868 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15869 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15870 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15871 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15872 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15873 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15874 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15875 content inspection.
15876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15878 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015879 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15880 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15881 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15882 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15885 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15886 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15887 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15888 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015891
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015892res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15893rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15894 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15895 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15896 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15897 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15898 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15899 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15900 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902wait_end : boolean
15903 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15904 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015905 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15907 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015908 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15910 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912 Examples :
15913 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15914 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15915 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15918 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15919 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15920 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15921 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15922 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15923 tcp-request content reject
15924
15925
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159267.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015927--------------------------------------
15928
15929It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15930This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15931data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15932its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15933HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15934content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15935to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15936more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15937response are indexed.
15938
15939base : string
15940 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15941 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15942 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15943 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15944 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15945 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15946 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15947 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15948
15949 ACL derivatives :
15950 base : exact string match
15951 base_beg : prefix match
15952 base_dir : subdir match
15953 base_dom : domain match
15954 base_end : suffix match
15955 base_len : length match
15956 base_reg : regex match
15957 base_sub : substring match
15958
15959base32 : integer
15960 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15961 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15962 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015963 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15964 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15965 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966
15967base32+src : binary
15968 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15969 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15970 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15971 per-URL counters.
15972
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015973capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15974 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15975 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15976 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15977
15978capture.req.method : string
15979 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15980 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15981 because it's allocated.
15982
15983capture.req.uri : string
15984 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15985 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15986 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15987 allocated.
15988
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015989capture.req.ver : string
15990 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15991 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15992 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15993
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015994capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15995 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15996 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15997 The first entry is an index of 0.
15998 See also: "capture response header"
15999
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016000capture.res.ver : string
16001 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16002 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16003 persistent flag.
16004
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016005req.body : binary
16006 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16007 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16008 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16009 the first chunk is analyzed.
16010
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016011req.body_param([<name>) : string
16012 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16013 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16014 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16015 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16016 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16017 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16018 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16019 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16020 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16021 given.
16022
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016023req.body_len : integer
16024 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16025 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16026 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16027 "option http-buffer-request".
16028
16029req.body_size : integer
16030 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16031 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16032 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16033 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16034 "option http-buffer-request".
16035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036req.cook([<name>]) : string
16037cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16038 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16039 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16040 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16041 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16042 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16043 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16044 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16045 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16046
16047 ACL derivatives :
16048 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16049 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16050 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16051 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16052 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16053 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16054 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16055 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16058cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16059 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16060 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16063cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16064 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16065 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16066 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16067 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16070 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16071 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16072 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16073 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016074 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16076 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16077 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16078 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016080hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16081 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16082 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16083 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16084 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016085 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16088 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16089 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16090 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16091 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16092 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16093 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16094 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16095 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16098 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16099 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16100 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16101 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016103req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16104 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16105 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16106 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16107 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16108 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16109 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16110 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16111 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016112 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016113 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016114 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116 ACL derivatives :
16117 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16118 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16119 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16120 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16121 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16122 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16123 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16124 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16125
16126req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16127hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16128 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16129 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16130 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16131 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16132 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16133 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16134 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16135 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16136 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16137
16138req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16139hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16140 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16141 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16142 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16143 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16144 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016145 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16147 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16148
16149req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16150hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16151 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16152 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16153 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16154 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16155 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16156 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16157 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16158
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016159
16160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016161http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16162 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16163 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16164 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16165 basic auth is supported.
16166
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016167http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16168 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16169 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16170 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16171 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016172 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16173 basic auth is supported.
16174
16175 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016176 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16177 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16178 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16179 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016180
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016181http_auth_pass : string
16182 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16183 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16184 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16185
16186http_auth_type : string
16187 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16188 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16189 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16190
16191http_auth_user : string
16192 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16193 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16194 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016196http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016197 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16198 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16200 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016202method : integer + string
16203 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16204 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16205 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16206 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16207 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16208 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16209 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016211 ACL derivatives :
16212 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016214 Example :
16215 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16216 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16217 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016219path : string
16220 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16221 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16222 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16223 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16224 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016225 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228 ACL derivatives :
16229 path : exact string match
16230 path_beg : prefix match
16231 path_dir : subdir match
16232 path_dom : domain match
16233 path_end : suffix match
16234 path_len : length match
16235 path_reg : regex match
16236 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016237
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016238query : string
16239 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16240 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16241 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16242 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016243 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016244 which stops before the question mark.
16245
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016246req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16247 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16248 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16249 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16250 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252req.ver : string
16253req_ver : string (deprecated)
16254 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16255 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16256 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258 ACL derivatives :
16259 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016261res.comp : boolean
16262 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16263 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16264 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266res.comp_algo : string
16267 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16268 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16269 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016271res.cook([<name>]) : string
16272scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16273 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16274 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16275 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016277 ACL derivatives :
16278 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016280res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16281scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16282 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16283 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16284 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16287scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16288 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16289 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16290 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016292res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16293 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16294 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16295 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16296 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16297 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16298 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16299 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16300 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16301 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16304 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16305 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16306 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16307 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16308 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16311shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16312 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16313 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16314 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16315 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16316 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16317 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16318 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16319 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016321 ACL derivatives :
16322 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16323 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16324 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16325 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16326 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16327 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16328 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16329 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16330
16331res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16332shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16333 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16334 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16335 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16336 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16337 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016339res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16340shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16341 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16342 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16343 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16344 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16345 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16346 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016347
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016348res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16349 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16350 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16351 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16352 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016354res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16355shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16356 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16357 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16358 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16359 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16360 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16361 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016363res.ver : string
16364resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16365 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16366 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016368 ACL derivatives :
16369 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016371set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16372 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16373 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016374 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016375 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16378 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016380status : integer
16381 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16382 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16383 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016384
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016385unique-id : string
16386 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16387 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16388 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16389 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16390 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16391 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016393url : string
16394 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16395 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16396 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16397 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16398 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16399 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16400 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016402 ACL derivatives :
16403 url : exact string match
16404 url_beg : prefix match
16405 url_dir : subdir match
16406 url_dom : domain match
16407 url_end : suffix match
16408 url_len : length match
16409 url_reg : regex match
16410 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016412url_ip : ip
16413 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16414 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16415 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16416 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16417 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16418 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16419 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016421url_port : integer
16422 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16423 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16424 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16425 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016426
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016427urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16428url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016429 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16430 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016431 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16432 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16433 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16434 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16436 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016437 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16438 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016440 ACL derivatives :
16441 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16442 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16443 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16444 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16445 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16446 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16447 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16448 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016449
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016451 Example :
16452 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16453 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16454 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16455 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016456
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016457urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016458 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16459 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16460 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016461
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016462url32 : integer
16463 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16464 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16465 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16466 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16467 is an unsigned integer.
16468
16469url32+src : binary
16470 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16471 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16472 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16473
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016474
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100164757.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16476---------------------------------------
16477
16478This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16479used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16480purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16481There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16482or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16483any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16484for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16485
16486internal.htx.data : integer
16487 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16488 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16489
16490internal.htx.free : integer
16491 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16492 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16493
16494internal.htx.free_data : integer
16495 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16496 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16497
16498internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16499 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16500 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16501 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16502
16503internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16504 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16505 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16506
16507internal.htx.size : integer
16508 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16509 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16510
16511internal.htx.used : integer
16512 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16513 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16514 direction.
16515
16516internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16517 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16518 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16519 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16520 of the special value :
16521 * head : The oldest inserted block
16522 * tail : The newest inserted block
16523 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16524
16525internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16526 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16527 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16528 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16529 integer or one of the special value :
16530 * head : The oldest inserted block
16531 * tail : The newest inserted block
16532 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16533
16534internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16535 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16536 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16537 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16538 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16539
16540 * head : The oldest inserted block
16541 * tail : The newest inserted block
16542 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16543
16544internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16545 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16546 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16547 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16548 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16549
16550 * head : The oldest inserted block
16551 * tail : The newest inserted block
16552 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16553
16554internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16555 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16556 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16557 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16558 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16559
16560 * head : The oldest inserted block
16561 * tail : The newest inserted block
16562 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16563
16564internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16565 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16566 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16567 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16568 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16569
16570 * head : The oldest inserted block
16571 * tail : The newest inserted block
16572 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16573
16574internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16575 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16576 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16577 it returns false.
16578
16579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200165807.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016581---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016583Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16584every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016585order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016587ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16588---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016589FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016590HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016591HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16592HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016593HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16594HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16595HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16596HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16597LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016598METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016599METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016600METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16601METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16602METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16603METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016604METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016605METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016606RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016607REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016608TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016609WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16610---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016611
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166138. Logging
16614----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016615
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016616One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16617provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16618very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16619provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16620state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016621to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016622headers.
16623
16624In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16625about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16626send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16627
16628 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16629 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16630 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16631 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16632 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016633 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016634 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016635
16636The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16637allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16638as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16639while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16640real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16641delay.
16642
16643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166448.1. Log levels
16645---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016646
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016647TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016648source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016649HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16650in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16651track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16652syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16653about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016654
16655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166568.2. Log formats
16657----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016658
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016659HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016660and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16661slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16662options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016663
16664 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16665 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16666 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16667 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16668 extents.
16669
16670 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16671 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16672 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16673 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16674 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16675
16676 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16677 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16678 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16679 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16680 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16681
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016682 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16683 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16684 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16685 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16686
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016687 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16688
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016689Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16690specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16691field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16692servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16693always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16694identifier.
16695
16696Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16697 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16698 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16699 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16700 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16701
16702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167038.2.1. Default log format
16704-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016705
16706This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16707as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16708format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16709
16710 Example :
16711 listen www
16712 mode http
16713 log global
16714 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16715
16716 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16717 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16718 (www/HTTP)
16719
16720 Field Format Extract from the example above
16721 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16722 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16723 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16724 4 'to' to
16725 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16726 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16727
16728Detailed fields description :
16729 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16730 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16731 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16732 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16733 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16734 and processed the connection.
16735 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16736
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016737In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16738"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16739connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16740
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016741It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16742will eventually disappear.
16743
16744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167458.2.2. TCP log format
16746---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016747
16748The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16749is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16750information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16751counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16752emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16753environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16754the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16755sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016756specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16757not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16758fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16759marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016760
16761 Example :
16762 frontend fnt
16763 mode tcp
16764 option tcplog
16765 log global
16766 default_backend bck
16767
16768 backend bck
16769 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16770
16771 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16772 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16773 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16774
16775 Field Format Extract from the example above
16776 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16777 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16778 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16779 4 frontend_name fnt
16780 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16781 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16782 7 bytes_read* 212
16783 8 termination_state --
16784 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16785 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16786
16787Detailed fields description :
16788 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016789 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16790 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16791 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016792 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016793 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016794 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016795
16796 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016797 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16798 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16799 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016800
16801 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16802 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16803 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016804 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16805 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16806 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16807 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016808
16809 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16810 and processed the connection.
16811
16812 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16813 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16814 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16815 applications.
16816
16817 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16818 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16819 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16820 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16821 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16822
16823 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16824 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16825 See "Timers" below for more details.
16826
16827 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16828 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16829 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16830 "Timers" below for more details.
16831
16832 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016833 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016834 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16835 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16836 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16837 details.
16838
16839 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16840 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16841 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16842 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16843 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16844
16845 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16846 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16847 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16848 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16849 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16850 for more details.
16851
16852 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016853 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016854 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16855 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16856 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016857 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016858
16859 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16860 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16861 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16862 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16863 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16864 caused by a denial of service attack.
16865
16866 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16867 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16868 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16869 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16870 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16871 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16872 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16873 denial of service attack.
16874
16875 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16876 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16877 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16878 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16879 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16880 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16881 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16882 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16883 be processed than on other servers.
16884
16885 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16886 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16887 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16888 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16889 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16890 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16891 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16892 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16893 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16894 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16895 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16896 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16897 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16898
16899 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16900 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16901 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16902 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16903 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16904 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016905 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016906 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16907
16908 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16909 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16910 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16911 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16912 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16913 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016914 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016915 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16916 occurs.
16917
16918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169198.2.3. HTTP log format
16920----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016921
16922The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16923is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16924the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16925are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16926emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16927generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16928"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16929which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016930frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16931is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016932
16933Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16934slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16935with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16936
16937 Example :
16938 frontend http-in
16939 mode http
16940 option httplog
16941 log global
16942 default_backend bck
16943
16944 backend static
16945 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16946
16947 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16948 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16949 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016950 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016951
16952 Field Format Extract from the example above
16953 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16954 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016955 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016956 4 frontend_name http-in
16957 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016958 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016959 7 status_code 200
16960 8 bytes_read* 2750
16961 9 captured_request_cookie -
16962 10 captured_response_cookie -
16963 11 termination_state ----
16964 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16965 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16966 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16967 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16968 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016969
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016970Detailed fields description :
16971 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016972 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16973 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16974 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016975 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016976 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016977 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016978
16979 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016980 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16981 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16982 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016983
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016984 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16985 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016986
16987 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16988 and processed the connection.
16989
16990 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16991 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16992 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16993
16994 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16995 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16996 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16997 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16998 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16999 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17000
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017001 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17002 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17003 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017004 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017005 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17006 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017007 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17008 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017009
17010 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17011 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017012 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017013
17014 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17015 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017016 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17017 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017018
17019 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17020 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17021 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17022 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17023 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017024 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17025 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017026
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017027 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17028 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17029 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17030 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17031 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17032 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17033 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017034 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017035
17036 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17037 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17038 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17039
17040 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17041 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017042 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017043 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17044 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17045 overflowing.
17046
17047 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17048 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17049 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17050 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17051 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17052 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17053 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17054 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17055
17056 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17057 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17058 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17059 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17060 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17061 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17062 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17063 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17064
17065 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17066 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17067 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17068 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17069 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17070 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17071 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17072
17073 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017074 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017075 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17076 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17077 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017078 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017079 system.
17080
17081 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17082 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17083 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17084 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17085 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17086 caused by a denial of service attack.
17087
17088 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17089 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17090 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17091 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17092 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17093 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17094 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17095 denial of service attack.
17096
17097 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17098 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17099 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17100 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17101 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17102 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17103 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17104 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17105 processed than on other servers.
17106
17107 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17108 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17109 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17110 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17111 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17112 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17113 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17114 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17115 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17116 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17117 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17118 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17119 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17120
17121 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17122 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17123 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17124 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17125 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17126 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017127 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017128 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17129
17130 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17131 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17132 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17133 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17134 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17135 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017136 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017137 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17138 occurs.
17139
17140 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17141 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17142 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17143 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17144 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17145 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17146 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17147 cookies" below for more details.
17148
17149 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17150 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17151 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17152 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17153 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17154 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17155 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17156 and cookies" below for more details.
17157
17158 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17159 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17160 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17161 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17162 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17163 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17164 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17165 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17166
17167
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200171688.2.4. Custom log format
17169------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017170
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017171The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017172mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017173
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017174HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017175Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17176separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17177prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17178
17179Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17180variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017181("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017182
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017183If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017184as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017185less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17186the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17187
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017188Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017189In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017190in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017191
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017192Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17193'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17194https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17195such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17196
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017197Flags are :
17198 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017199 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017200 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17201 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017202
17203 Example:
17204
17205 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17206 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17207
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017208 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17209
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017210At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17211
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017212 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17213 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017214
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017215the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017216
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017217 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17218 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17219 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017220
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017221and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17222
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017223 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17224 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017225
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017226Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17227
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017228 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017229 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017230 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17231 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17232 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017233 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17234 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17235 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017236 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017237 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17238 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017239 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017240 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17241 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017242 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017243 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017244 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017245 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017246 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017247 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017248 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017249 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17250 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17251 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17252 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17253 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017254 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017255 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17256 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017257 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017258 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17259 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017260 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17261 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17262 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017263 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017264 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17265 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017266 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017267 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17268 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17269 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017270 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017271 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017272 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17273 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17274 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17275 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017276 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017277 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017278 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017279 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017280 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017281 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017282 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17283 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17284 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017285 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017286 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17287 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017288 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017289 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17290 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017291 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017292 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017293 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017294 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017295
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017296 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017297
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017298
172998.2.5. Error log format
17300-----------------------
17301
17302When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17303protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17304By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17305"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017306will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017307logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17308
17309The format looks like this :
17310
17311 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17312 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17313 Connection error during SSL handshake
17314
17315 Field Format Extract from the example above
17316 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17317 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17318 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17319 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17320 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17321
17322These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17323failures.
17324
17325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173268.3. Advanced logging options
17327-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017328
17329Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17330just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17331options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17332for more information about their usage.
17333
17334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173358.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17336------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017337
17338It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17339haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17340commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17341monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17342ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17343
17344 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17345 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17346 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17347 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17348
17349 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17350 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17351 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017352 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017353 such as other load-balancers.
17354
17355 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17356 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17357 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17358
17359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173608.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17361----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017362
17363The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17364what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17365or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017366"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017367just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17368log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17369after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17370is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17371with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17372with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17373
17374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173758.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17376------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017377
17378Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17379for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17380"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17381retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17382raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17383a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17384file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17385you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17386"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17387
17388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173898.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17390--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017391
17392Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17393multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17394them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17395"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17396logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17397error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17398and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17399too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17400useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17401alternative.
17402
17403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174048.4. Timing events
17405------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017406
17407Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17408reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17409the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17410frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017411mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17412addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17413
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017414Timings events in HTTP mode:
17415
17416 first request 2nd request
17417 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17418 t tr t tr ...
17419 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17420 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17421 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17422 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17423 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17424
17425Timings events in TCP mode:
17426
17427 TCP session
17428 |<----------------->|
17429 t t
17430 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17431 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17432 |<------ Tt ------->|
17433
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017434 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017435 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017436 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17437 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17438 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017439 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017440 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17441 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17442 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17443 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017444
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017445 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17446 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17447 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017448 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17449 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17450 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17451 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17452 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17453 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017454
17455 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17456 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17457 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17458 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17459 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17460 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17461 request typed by hand during a test.
17462
17463 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17464 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017465 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017466 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17467 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17468 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17469 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017470
17471 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17472 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17473 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17474 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17475 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17476
17477 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17478 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17479 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17480 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17481 connection never established.
17482
17483 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17484 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17485 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17486 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17487 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17488 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17489 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17490 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17491 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17492 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17493 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17494
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017495 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17496 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17497 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17498 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17499 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17500 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17501
17502 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17503
17504 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17505 "Ta" can never be negative.
17506
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017507 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17508 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017509 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17510 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017511 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017512
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017513 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017514
17515 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017516 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17517 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017518
17519These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17520protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17521that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017522due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17523"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17524that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017525
17526Most common cases :
17527
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017528 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17529 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17530 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17531 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17532 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17533 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17534 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17535 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17536 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17537 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17538 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017539 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017540
17541 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17542 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17543 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17544 of ms on remote networks.
17545
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017546 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17547 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17548 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017549
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017550 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17551 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17552 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17553 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17554 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17555 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17556 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17557 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17558 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017559
17560Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17561
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017562 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017563 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017564 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017565
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017566 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017567 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17568 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17569
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017570 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017571 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17572 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17573 flags.
17574
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017575 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17576 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017577 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17578 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17579 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17580 the client connection was maintained open.
17581
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017582 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017583 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017584 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017585 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17586
17587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175888.5. Session state at disconnection
17589-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017590
17591TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17592"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
175932-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17594each of which has a special meaning :
17595
17596 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17597 session to terminate :
17598
17599 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17600
17601 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17602 server explicitly refused it.
17603
17604 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17605 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17606 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17607 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017608 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017609
17610 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17611 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017612
17613 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17614 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17615 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17616 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17617 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17618
17619 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17620 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17621 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17622 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17623 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17624
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017625 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17626 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17627
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017628 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17629 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17630 backup connections when going up.
17631
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017632 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17633
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017634 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17635 send or receive data.
17636
17637 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17638 send or receive data.
17639
17640 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17641 with nothing left in the buffers.
17642
17643 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17644
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017645 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017646 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17647
17648 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17649 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17650 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17651 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17652 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17653
17654 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17655 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17656
17657 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17658 server (HTTP only).
17659
17660 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17661
17662 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17663 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17664 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17665
17666 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17667 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17668 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17669
17670 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17671
17672 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17673 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17674
17675 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17676 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17677 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17678
17679 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17680 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017681 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17682 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017683
17684 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17685 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17686 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17687 another server.
17688
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017689 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017690 server.
17691
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017692 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17693 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17694 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17695 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17696
17697 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17698 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17699 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17700 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17701
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017702 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17703 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17704 "use-server" rule).
17705
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017706 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17707
17708 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17709 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17710
17711 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17712
17713 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17714 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17715 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17716
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017717 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17718 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017719 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017720 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17721 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17722
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017723 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17724
17725 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17726 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17727
17728 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17729
17730 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17731
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017732The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17733was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017734helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17735starvation, attacks, etc...
17736
17737The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17738alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17739easier finding and understanding.
17740
17741 Flags Reason
17742
17743 -- Normal termination.
17744
17745 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17746 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17747 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17748 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17749
17750 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17751 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17752 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17753 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17754 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17755 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017756
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017757 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17758 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017759 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017760
17761 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17762 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17763 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17764
17765 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17766 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17767 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17768 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17769 the server takes too long to respond.
17770
17771 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17772 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17773 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17774 long a time to respond.
17775
17776 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17777 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17778 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17779 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017780 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17781 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017782
17783 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17784 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17785 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17786 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17787 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017788 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017789 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17790 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17791 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17792 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17793 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17794 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17795 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17796 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017797 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017798 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17799 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17800 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017801
17802 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17803 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017804 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17805 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17806 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17807 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017808
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017809 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17810 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017812 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017813 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17814 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017815 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017816 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17817 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17818
17819 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17820 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17821 503 or 504 here.
17822
17823 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17824 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17825 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17826 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17827 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17828
17829 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17830 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017831 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017832 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17833 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17834
17835 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17836 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17837 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17838 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17839 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17840 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17841 between haproxy and the server.
17842
17843 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17844 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17845 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17846 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17847 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17848 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17849 solution is to fix the application.
17850
17851 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17852 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17853 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17854 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17855 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17856 external attacks.
17857
17858 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17859 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017860 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017861 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17862 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17863
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017864 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17865 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17866 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017867 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017868 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017869
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017870 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17871 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17872 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17873 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017874 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17875 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17876 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17877 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17878 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017879
17880 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17881 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17882 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17883 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17884
17885 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17886 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17887 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17888 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17889
17890 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17891 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17892 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17893 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17894
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017895The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17896persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17897important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17898re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17899
17900 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17901
17902 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17903 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17904 set on a GET request.
17905
17906 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17907 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017908 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017909 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17910
17911 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17912 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17913 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17914
17915 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17916 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17917 already got a cookie.
17918
17919 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17920 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17921 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17922 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17923 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17924
17925 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17926 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17927 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17928
17929 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17930 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17931 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17932
17933 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17934 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17935
17936 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17937 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17938 then advertised in the response.
17939
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179418.6. Non-printable characters
17942-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017943
17944In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17945consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17946converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17947prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17948being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17949escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17950is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17951'}' when logging headers.
17952
17953Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17954issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17955containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17956
17957Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17958the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17959performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17960
17961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179628.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17963---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017964
17965Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17966achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017967section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017968cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17969the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17970the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017971locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017972not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17973user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17974a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17975wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17976
17977 Examples :
17978 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17979 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17980
17981 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17982 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17983
17984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179858.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17986---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017987
17988Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17989proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17990the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17991server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17992
17993Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17994response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017995section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017996
17997It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017998time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17999appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018000are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18001and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18002follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18003request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18004in the logs.
18005
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018006As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18007frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18008an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18009
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018010 Example :
18011 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18012 listen proxy-out
18013 mode http
18014 option httplog
18015 option logasap
18016 log global
18017 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18018
18019 # log the name of the virtual server
18020 capture request header Host len 20
18021
18022 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18023 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18024
18025 # log the beginning of the referrer
18026 capture request header Referer len 20
18027
18028 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18029 capture response header Server len 20
18030
18031 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18032 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18033
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018034 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018035 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18036
18037 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18038 capture response header Via len 20
18039
18040 # log the URL location during a redirection
18041 capture response header Location len 20
18042
18043 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18044 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18045 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18046 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18047 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18048
18049 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18050 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18051 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18052 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018053 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018054
18055 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18056 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18057 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18058 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18059 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018060 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018061
18062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180638.9. Examples of logs
18064---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018065
18066These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18067them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18068reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18069
18070 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18071 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18072 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18073
18074 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18075 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18076
18077 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18078 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18079 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18080
18081 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18082 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18083
18084 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18085 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18086 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18087
18088 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018089 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018090 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18091 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18092
18093 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18094 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18095 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18096
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018097 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18098 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18099 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18100 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18101 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18102 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018103
18104 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018105 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018106
18107 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18108 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18109 Nothing was sent to any server.
18110
18111 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18112 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18113
18114 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18115 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018116 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018117 send a 408 return code to the client.
18118
18119 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18120 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18121
18122 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18123 5 seconds ("c----").
18124
18125 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18126 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018127 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018128
18129 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018130 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018131 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18132 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18133 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18134 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18135 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018136
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018137
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200181389. Supported filters
18139--------------------
18140
18141Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18142accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18143unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18144
18145See also : "filter"
18146
181479.1. Trace
18148----------
18149
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018150filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018151
18152 Arguments:
18153 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18154 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18155
18156 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18157 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18158 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18159 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18160
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018161 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018162 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18163 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18164 amount of the parsed data.
18165
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018166 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018167
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018168This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18169callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18170information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18171filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18172
18173Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18174tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18175a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18176
18177
181789.2. HTTP compression
18179---------------------
18180
18181filter compression
18182
18183The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18184keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018185when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18186fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18187done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18188explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18189filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18190listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18191order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018192
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018193See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18194 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018195
18196
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200181979.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18198--------------------------------------------
18199
18200filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18201
18202 Arguments :
18203
18204 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18205 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18206 parsed.
18207
18208 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18209 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18210 part must be placed in its own scope.
18211
18212The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18213external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018214streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018215exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18216also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18217
18218SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18219the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18220
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018221For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018222"doc/SPOE.txt".
18223
18224Important note:
18225 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18226 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18227
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100182289.4. Cache
18229----------
18230
18231filter cache <name>
18232
18233 Arguments :
18234
18235 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18236
18237The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18238"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018239cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018240other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18241case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18242is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18243filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018244listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18245order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018246
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018247See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18248 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18249
18250
182519.5. Fcgi-app
18252-------------
18253
18254filter fcg-app <name>
18255
18256 Arguments :
18257
18258 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18259
18260The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18261request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18262reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18263used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18264implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18265used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18266fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18267used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18268order.
18269
18270See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18271 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18272
18273
1827410. FastCGI applications
18275-------------------------
18276
18277HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18278feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18279the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18280FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18281servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18282FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18283backend.
18284
18285HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18286application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18287connection.
18288
1828910.1. Setup
18290-----------
18291
1829210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18293--------------------------
18294
18295fcgi-app <name>
18296 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18297 document root must be defined.
18298
18299acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18300 Declare or complete an access list.
18301
18302 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18303 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18304 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18305 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18306 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18307
18308docroot <path>
18309 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18310 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18311 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18312
18313index <script-name>
18314 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18315 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18316 is an optional setting.
18317
18318 Example :
18319 index index.php
18320
18321log-stderr global
18322log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18323 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18324 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18325
18326 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18327 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18328
18329pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18330 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18331 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18332 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18333
18334 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18335 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18336 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18337 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18338
18339 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18340 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18341
18342path-info <regex>
18343 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18344 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18345 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18346 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18347 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18348
18349 Example :
18350 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18351
18352option get-values
18353no option get-values
18354 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18355
18356 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18357 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18358
18359 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18360 application will accept.
18361
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018362 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18363 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018364
18365 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18366 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18367 option is disabled.
18368
18369 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18370 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18371 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18372 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18373 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18374 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18375
18376option keep-conn
18377no option keep-conn
18378 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18379 sending a response.
18380
18381 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18382 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18383
18384option max-reqs <reqs>
18385 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18386 accept.
18387
18388 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18389 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18390 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18391 to 1.
18392
18393option mpxs-conns
18394no option mpxs-conns
18395 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18396
18397 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18398 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18399
18400set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18401 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18402 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18403 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18404 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18405
18406 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18407 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18408 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18409
18410 Example :
18411 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18412 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18413
18414 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18415
18416
1841710.1.2. Proxy section
18418---------------------
18419
18420use-fcgi-app <name>
18421 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18422
18423 Arguments :
18424 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18425
18426 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18427 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18428 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18429 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18430 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18431
18432 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18433 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18434 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18435 application are evaluated.
18436
18437
1843810.1.3. Example
18439---------------
18440
18441 frontend front-http
18442 mode http
18443 bind *:80
18444 bind *:
18445
18446 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18447 default_backend back-static
18448
18449 backend back-static
18450 mode http
18451 server www A.B.C.D:80
18452
18453 backend back-dynamic
18454 mode http
18455 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18456 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18457
18458 fcgi-app php-fpm
18459 log-stderr global
18460 option keep-conn
18461
18462 docroot /var/www/my-app
18463 index index.php
18464 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18465
18466
1846710.2. Default parameters
18468------------------------
18469
18470A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18471the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18472scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18473applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18474
18475 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18476 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18477 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18478 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18479 | | |
18480 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18481 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18482 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18483 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18484 | | application. |
18485 | | |
18486 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18487 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18488 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18489 | | |
18490 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18491 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18492 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18493 | | the application's configuration. |
18494 | | |
18495 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18496 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18497 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18498 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18499 | | |
18500 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18501 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18502 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18503 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18504 | | be defined. |
18505 | | |
18506 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18507 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18508 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18509 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18510 | | is not set too. |
18511 | | |
18512 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18513 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18514 | | set. |
18515 | | |
18516 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18517 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18518 | | the request. |
18519 | | |
18520 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18521 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18522 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18523 | | |
18524 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18525 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18526 | | script to process the request. |
18527 | | |
18528 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18529 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18530 | | |
18531 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18532 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18533 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18534 | | |
18535 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18536 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18537 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18538 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18539 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18540 | | |
18541 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18542 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18543 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18544 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18545 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18546 | | side. |
18547 | | |
18548 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18549 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18550 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18551 | | connected to. |
18552 | | |
18553 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18554 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18555 | | |
18556 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18557 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18558 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18559 | | |
18560 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18561
18562
1856310.3. Limitations
18564------------------
18565
18566The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18567way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18568during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18569establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18570application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18571or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18572message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18573these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18574and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18575
18576Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18577request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18578requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18579
18580About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18581into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18582fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18583"http-request" ones.
18584
18585Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18586FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18587processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18588must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18589here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018591/*
18592 * Local variables:
18593 * fill-column: 79
18594 * End:
18595 */